blob: 676d5a07559e455dcca12f481578cd64b62336bc [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200675 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200676 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200677 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100678 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200679 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200680 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100681 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100683 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.session-timeout
685 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200686 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100687 - tune.maxaccept
688 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200690 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200691 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.rcvbuf.client
693 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100694 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200695 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.sndbuf.client
697 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100698 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200700 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200702 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200703 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100704 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100706 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
708 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
709 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100710 - tune.zlib.memlevel
711 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 * Debugging
714 - debug
715 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200716 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720------------------------------------
721
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722ca-base <dir>
723 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100724 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
725 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
726 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728chroot <jail dir>
729 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
730 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
731 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
732 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
733 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
737 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
738 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
739 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
740 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
741 set. These sets have the format
742
743 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
744
745 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
748 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100749 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
750 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
756 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
757 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
758 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100759
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100760 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
761 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
762 on the machine's word size.
763
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
766 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
767 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
768 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
769 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
770 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771
772 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
774
775 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
776 # first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
779 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
780 # word size.
781
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
789 # and so on.
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100794 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100795 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
796 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
797 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
798
799 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
800 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
802
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100803 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
804 # and a thread range.
805 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
808
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809crt-base <dir>
810 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100811 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
812 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814daemon
815 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
816 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100817 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
818 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820deviceatlas-json-file <path>
821 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100822 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823
824deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
827
828deviceatlas-separator <char>
829 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
830 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
831
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100832deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200833 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
834 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
835 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900837external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100838 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
839 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100840 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
841 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
842 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
843 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
844 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846gid <number>
847 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
848 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
849 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100850 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
851 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100853
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100854group <group name>
855 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
856 See also "gid" and "user".
857
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100858hard-stop-after <time>
859 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
860
861 Arguments :
862 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
863 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
864 SIGUSR1 signal.
865
866 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
867 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
868 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
869
870 Example:
871 global
872 hard-stop-after 30s
873
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200874h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
875 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
876 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
877 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
878 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500879 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
881 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
882 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
883 specified in a proxy.
884
885 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
886 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
887 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
888 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
889 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
890 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
891 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
892
893 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
894 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
895 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
896 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
897 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
898
899 Example:
900 global
901 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
902
903 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
904 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
905
906h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
907 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
908 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
909 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
910 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
911 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
912 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
913 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
914 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
915
916 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
917 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
918 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
919
920 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
921 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
922
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100923insecure-fork-wanted
924 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
925 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
926 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
927 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
928 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
929 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
930 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
931 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
932 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
933 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
934 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
935 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
936 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
937 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
938 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
939 disable it.
940
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100941insecure-setuid-wanted
942 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
943 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
944 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
945 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
946 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
947 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
948 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
949 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
950 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
951 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
952 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
953 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
954 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
955 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
956
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100957issuers-chain-path <dir>
958 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
959 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
960 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
961 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
962 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
963 "issuers-chain-path".
964 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
965 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
966 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
967 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
968 will share the chain in memory.
969
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200970log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
971 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100972 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100973 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100974 configured with "log global".
975
976 <address> can be one of:
977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100978 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100982 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
983 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
984 port).
985
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100986 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
988 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100991 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
992 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
993 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
994 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
995 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
996 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
997 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
998 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
999 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1000 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1001 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1002 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1003 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1004 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001005 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1006 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007
1008 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1009 "fd@2", see above.
1010
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001011 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1012 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1013 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1014 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1015 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1016
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001017 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1018 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001019
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001020 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1021 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1022 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1023 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1024 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1025 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1026 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1027 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1028 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1029 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1031 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001033 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1034 one of the following :
1035
1036 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1037 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1038
1039 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1040 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1041
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001042 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1043 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1044 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1045 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1046 logger consumes.
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1049 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1050 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1051 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1052
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001053 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1054 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1055 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1056 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1057 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1058
1059 <sample_size>
1060 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1061 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1062 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1063 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1064 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1065
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001066 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001068 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1069 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1070 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1071
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001072 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1073 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1074 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1075 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001078 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1079 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1080 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1081 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1082 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1083 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001087log-send-hostname [<string>]
1088 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1089 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1090 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1091 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1092 the logs.
1093
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001094log-tag <string>
1095 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1096 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1097 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001098 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001099
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100lua-load <file>
1101 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1102 used multiple times.
1103
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1105 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1106 variable.
1107 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1108 to "path".
1109
1110 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1111 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1112 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1113 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1114 will be checked earlier.
1115
1116 As an example by specifying the following path:
1117
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1120
1121 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1124 paths if that does not exist either.
1125
1126 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1127 documentation.
1128
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001129master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1131 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1132 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001134 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1135 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001136 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1137 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1138 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1139 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1140 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001144mworker-max-reloads <number>
1145 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001146 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001147 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1148 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1149 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151nbproc <number>
1152 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1153 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1154 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001155 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1156 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001157 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1158 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001160nbthread <number>
1161 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001162 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1163 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1164 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1165 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1166 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1168 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1169 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1170 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1171 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1172 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1173 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1178 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180presetenv <name> <value>
1181 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1182 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1183 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1184 and "unsetenv".
1185
1186resetenv [<name> ...]
1187 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1188 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1189 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1190 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1191 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1192 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1193 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1194 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001196stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001197 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1198 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1199 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1200 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1201 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1202 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001203 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1205 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1206 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1207 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001208
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001209server-state-base <directory>
1210 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001211 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1212 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001213
1214server-state-file <file>
1215 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1216 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1217 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1218 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1219 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1220 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1221 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1222 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001223 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1224 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001225
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001226setenv <name> <value>
1227 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1228 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1229 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1230 and "unsetenv".
1231
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001232set-dumpable
1233 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001234 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1235 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1236 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1237 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1238 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1239 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1240 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1241 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1242 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1243 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1244 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1245 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1246 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1247 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1248 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1249 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1250 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001251
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001252ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1254 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001255 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001256 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001257 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1258 information and recommendations see e.g.
1259 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1260 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1261 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1262 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001263
1264ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1266 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1267 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1268 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1269 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001270 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1271 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1272 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001273 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001274
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001275ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1277 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1278 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1279 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1280 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1281
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1285 keyword to see available options.
1286
1287 Example:
1288 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001289 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1293 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1300 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1302 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1307 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1308 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1309 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1313 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1318 keyword to see available options.
1319
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001320ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1322 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1323 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001325 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001326 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1327 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1328 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1329 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001330 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1331 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1332 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1333
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001334ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001335 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1336 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1337
1338 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1339 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1340 optimize the startup time.
1341
1342 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1343 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1344 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1345
1346 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001347 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348
1349 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1350 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1351 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1352 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1353 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1354 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001356 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1357
1358 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1359
1360 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1361
1362 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1363 not provided in the PEM file.
1364
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001365 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1366 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1367
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001368 The default behavior is "all".
1369
1370 Example:
1371 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1372 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1373 ssl-load-extra-files none
1374
1375 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1376
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001377ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1378 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1379 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1380 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1381
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001382ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1383 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1384 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1385 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1386 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1387 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1388 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1389 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1390 bits does not need it.
1391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001392stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1393 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1394 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1395 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001396 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001397 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001399 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1400 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1401 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001402
1403stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1404 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1405 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001406 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001407
1408stats maxconn <connections>
1409 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1410 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1411
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412uid <number>
1413 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1414 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1415 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1416 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1417
1418ulimit-n <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1420 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1421 option.
1422
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001423unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1424 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1425
1426 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1427 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1428 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1429 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1430 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1431 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1432 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1433 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1434 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1435 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1436
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001437unsetenv [<name> ...]
1438 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1439 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1440 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1441 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1442 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1443 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1444 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446user <user name>
1447 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1448 See also "uid" and "group".
1449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001450node <name>
1451 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1452
1453 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1454 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1455 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1456 traffic.
1457
1458description <text>
1459 Add a text that describes the instance.
1460
1461 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1462 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1463 "<" and ">" characters.
1464
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146551degrees-data-file <file path>
1466 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001467 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1474 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1475 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1476
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001478 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1479
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001481 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1482 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
148751degrees-cache-size <number>
1488 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1489 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1490 By default, this cache is disabled.
1491
1492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001495wurfl-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1497 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1498
1499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1500 with USE_WURFL=1.
1501
1502wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1503 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1504 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1505 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1506
1507 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1508
1509 Valid WURFL properties are:
1510 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1511
1512 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1513 device.
1514
1515 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1516 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1517
1518 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1519 particular web request.
1520
1521 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1522 used Libwurfl API version.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1525 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1526
1527 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1528 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1529
1530 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1531
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1533 with USE_WURFL=1.
1534
1535wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1536 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1537 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1543 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1544 thus before the chroot.
1545
1546 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1547 with USE_WURFL=1.
1548
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001549wurfl-cache-size <size>
1550 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1551 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001552 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001553 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554
1555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1556 with USE_WURFL=1.
1557
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001558strict-limits
1559 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1560 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1561 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1562 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1563 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1564 keyword.
1565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567-----------------------
1568
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001569busy-polling
1570 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1571 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1572 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1573 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1574 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1575 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1576 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1577 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1578 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1579 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1580 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1581 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1582 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1583 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1584 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1585 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1586 "poll" pollers.
1587
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001588 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1589 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1590 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1591
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001592max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1593 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1594 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1595 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1596 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1597 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1598 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1599 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1600 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602maxconn <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1604 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1605 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001606 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1607 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1608 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1609 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001610 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1611 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1612 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1613 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1614 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1615 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001617maxconnrate <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1619 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1620 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1621 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1622 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1623 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1624 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1625 fairness.
1626
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001627maxcomprate <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001630 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1631 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1632 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001633 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001634 default value.
1635
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001636maxcompcpuusage <number>
1637 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1638 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1639 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1640 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1641 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1642 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1643 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1644 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1645
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001646maxpipes <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1648 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1649 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1650 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1651 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1652 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1653
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001654maxsessrate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1656 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1657 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1658 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1659 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1660 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1661 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1662 fairness.
1663
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001664maxsslconn <number>
1665 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1666 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1667 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1668 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1669 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1670 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1671 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001672 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1673 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1674 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1675 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1676 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1677 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1678 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001680maxsslrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1682 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1683 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1684 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1685 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1686 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1687 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1688 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1689 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1690 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1691
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001692maxzlibmem <number>
1693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1694 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1695 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001696 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1697 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1698 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700noepoll
1701 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704
1705nokqueue
1706 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1707 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1708 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1709
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001710noevports
1711 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1712 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1713 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1714 also "nopoll".
1715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716nopoll
1717 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1718 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001720 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1721 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001723nosplice
1724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1731 "option splice-response".
1732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001733nogetaddrinfo
1734 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1735 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1736
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001737noreuseport
1738 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1739 command line argument "-dR".
1740
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001741profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1742 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1743 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1744 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1745 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001747 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1748 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1749 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1750 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1751
1752 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1753 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1754 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1755 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1756 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001757 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1758 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1759 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1760 CLI.
1761
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001762spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001763 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1764 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1765 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1766 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1767 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1768 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001771 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001773 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1774 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1775 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1776 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1777 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1779 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001780 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1781 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1782 openssl configuration file uses:
1783 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1784
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785ssl-mode-async
1786 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001787 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001788 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1789 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1790 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001792 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001793
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001794tune.buffers.limit <number>
1795 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1796 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1797 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1798 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1799 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001801 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1802 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1803 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1804 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1805 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1806 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1807 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1808 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1809 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1810
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001811tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1812 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1813 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1814 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1815 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.bufsize <number>
1818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1826 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1827 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001828 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001829 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1830 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1831 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001833tune.chksize <number>
1834 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1835 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1836 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1837 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1838 checks whenever possible.
1839
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001840tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1841 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1842 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1843 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1844 this value. The default value is 1.
1845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001846tune.fail-alloc
1847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1848 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1849 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1850 gracefully.
1851
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001852tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1853 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1854 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1855 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1856 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1857 change it.
1858
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001859tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1862 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001863 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1864 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1865 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1866 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1867 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1868
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001869tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1870 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1871 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1872 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1873 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1874 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1875 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1876 recommended not to change this value.
1877
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001878tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1879 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1880 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1881 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1882 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1883 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1884 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1885 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1886
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001887tune.http.cookielen <number>
1888 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1889 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1890 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1891 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1892 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1893 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1894 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1895 to change this value.
1896
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001897tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1899 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001900 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001902 configuration directives too.
1903 The default value is 1024.
1904
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001905tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1906 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1907 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1908 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1909 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1910 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1911 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001912 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1913 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1914 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001915
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001916tune.idletimer <timeout>
1917 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1918 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1919 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1920 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1921 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1922 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001924 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001925 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1926
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001927tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1928 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1929 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1930 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1931 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1932 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1933 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1934 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1935 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1936 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001938tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1939 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001940 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001941 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1942 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001944 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1945 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1946
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001947tune.lua.maxmem
1948 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1949 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1950 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1951 memory.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1954 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001955 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1956 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001958
1959tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1960 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1961 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1962 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1963 check servers.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001965tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1966 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1967 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1968 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001971tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001972 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1973 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1974 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1975 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1976 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1977 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1978 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1979 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1980 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1981 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001982
1983tune.maxpollevents <number>
1984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001990tune.maxrewrite <number>
1991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2000 bufsize.
2001
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002002tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2003 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2004 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2005 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2006 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2007 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2008 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2009 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2010 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2011 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002012 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2013 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002014 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2015 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2016 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2017 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2018 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2019 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2020 setting this parameter to 0.
2021
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002022tune.pipesize <number>
2023 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2024 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2025 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2026 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2027 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2028 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2029
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002030tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2031 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2032 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2033 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2034 default is 20.
2035
2036tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2037 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2038 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2039 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2040 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2041 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2042 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002043 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002044
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002045tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2046tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2047 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2048 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2049 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002050 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002052 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2053 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2054
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002055tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002056 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002057 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2058 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2059 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2060 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2061
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002062tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002064 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2065 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2066
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2068tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2069 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2070 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2071 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002072 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002074 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2075 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2076 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2077 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2078 notifying haproxy again.
2079
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002080tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002081 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2082 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2083 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002085 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002087 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2088 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2089 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002090 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2091 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002092
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002093tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002094 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002095 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2096 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2097 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2098 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2099 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2100
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002101tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2102 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002103 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002104 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2105 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2106 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2107 being used for too long.
2108
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002109tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2110 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2111 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2112 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2113 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2114 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2115 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2116 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2117 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2118 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2119 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002121 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002122
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002123tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2124 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2125 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2126 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2127 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2128 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2129 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2130 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002131 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2132 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002133
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002134tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2135 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2136 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2137 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2138 1000 entries.
2139
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002140tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2141 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2142 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2143 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2144
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002145tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002146tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2148tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002150 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2151 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2152 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2153 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2154 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2155 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2156 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2157 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002159 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2160 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2161 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2162 all available space is consumed.
2163 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2164 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2165 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002166
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002167tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2168 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002169 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002170 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002172 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2173
2174tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2175 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2176 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2178 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021803.3. Debugging
2181--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002183debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2185 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2186 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2187 system startup.
2188
2189quiet
2190 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2191 line argument "-q".
2192
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002193zero-warning
2194 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2195 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2196 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2197 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2198 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2199 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022023.4. Userlists
2203--------------
2204It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2205http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2206it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2207
2208userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002209 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002210 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2211
2212group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002213 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002214 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2215 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2218 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002219 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2220 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002221 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2222 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2223 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2224 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002226 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2227 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2228 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2229 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2230 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2231 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2232 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2233 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2234 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002235
2236 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L1
2238 group G1 users tiger,scott
2239 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002245 userlist L2
2246 group G1
2247 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002249 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2250 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2251 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252
2253 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255
22563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002257----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002258It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2259several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2260instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2261values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2262automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2263In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2264using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2265tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2266reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2267Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2268that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2269each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
2271peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002272 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002273 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2274
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002275bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2276 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2277 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2278
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002279disabled
2280 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2281 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2282 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2283
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002284default-bind [param*]
2285 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2286
2287default-server [param*]
2288 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2289
2290 Arguments:
2291 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2292 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2293 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2294 details.
2295
2296
2297 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2298
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002299enable
2300 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2301
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002302log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2303 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2304 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2305 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2306 more details.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2310 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2311 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2312 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2313 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2314 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2315
2316 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2317 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2318
2319 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2320 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2321 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2322 across all peers.
2323
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002324 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2325 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002326
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002327 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2328 "server" keyword explanation below).
2329
2330server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002331 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2333 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2334 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2335 of this "peers" section).
2336 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2337
2338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002339 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002340 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002341 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002342 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2343 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2344 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002345
2346 backend mybackend
2347 mode tcp
2348 balance roundrobin
2349 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2350 stick on src
2351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 Example:
2356 peers mypeers
2357 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2358 default-server ssl verify none
2359 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2360 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002362
2363table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2364 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2365
2366 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2367 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002368 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002369 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2370 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2371 "stick-table" keyword).
2372
2373 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2374 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2375 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2376 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2377 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2378 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2379 of the stick-table name as follows:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 ...
2385
2386 frontend fe1
2387 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2388
2389 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2390 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2391
2392 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2393 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2394 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2395 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2396 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2397 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2398 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2399
2400 peers mypeers
2401 peer A ...
2402 peer B ...
2403 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2404
2405 backend t1
2406 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2407
2408 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2409 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2410 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2411
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024123.6. Mailers
2413------------
2414It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2415If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2416in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2417
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002418mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2420 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2421
2422mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2423 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2424
2425 Example:
2426 mailers mymailers
2427 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2428 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2429
2430 backend mybackend
2431 mode tcp
2432 balance roundrobin
2433
2434 email-alert mailers mymailers
2435 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2436 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2437
2438 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2439 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2440
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002441timeout mail <time>
2442 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2443 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2444 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2445 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2446
2447 Example:
2448 mailers mymailers
2449 timeout mail 20s
2450 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002451
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024523.7. Programs
2453-------------
2454In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2455master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2456managed the same way as the workers.
2457
2458During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2459sequence as a worker:
2460
2461 - the master is re-executed
2462 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2463 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2464 instance of the program
2465
2466During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2467
2468program <name>
2469 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2470 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2471 the management guide).
2472
2473command <command> [arguments*]
2474 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2475 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2476 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2477 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2478
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002479user <user name>
2480 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2481 See also "group".
2482
2483group <group name>
2484 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2485 See also "user".
2486
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002487option start-on-reload
2488no option start-on-reload
2489 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2490 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2491 program section.
2492
2493
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024943.8. HTTP-errors
2495----------------
2496
2497It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2498imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2499several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2500
2501http-errors <name>
2502 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2503 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2504
2505errorfile <code> <file>
2506 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2507
2508 Arguments :
2509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2511 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2512
2513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2517 before any chroot is performed.
2518
2519 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2520
2521 Example:
2522 http-errors website-1
2523 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2524 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2526
2527 http-errors website-2
2528 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2529 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2530 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2531
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002537 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 - frontend <name>
2539 - backend <name>
2540 - listen <name>
2541
2542A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2543its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2544section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002546
2547A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2548connections.
2549
2550A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2551to forward incoming connections.
2552
2553A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2554parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2557'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2558case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2559
2560Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2561logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2562proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2563However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2564name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2565
2566Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2567and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2570modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2571arbitrary criteria.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2574a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002575the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002576
2577 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2578 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2579 between responses and new requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002581 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2582 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2583 client-facing connection remains open.
2584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2586 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002587
2588The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2589frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2590following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002593 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002595 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2596 ----+-----+-----+----
2597 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2598 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002599 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2600 ----+-----+-----+----
2601 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2606--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002608The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2609limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2610they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2611limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002613option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002614and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2615with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2616specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002618
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2621acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622backlog X X X -
2623balance X - X X
2624bind - X X -
2625bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626capture cookie - X X -
2627capture request header - X X -
2628capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002629compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002631declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632default-server X - X X
2633default_backend X X X -
2634description - X X X
2635disabled X X X X
2636dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002637email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002638email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002639email-alert mailers X X X X
2640email-alert myhostname X X X X
2641email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002642enabled X X X X
2643errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002644errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002645errorloc X X X X
2646errorloc302 X X X X
2647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2648errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002649force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002650filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651fullconn X - X X
2652grace X X X X
2653hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002654http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002656http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002657http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002659http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002660http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002661http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002663ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002664load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002665log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002666log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002667log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002668log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002669max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002670maxconn X X X -
2671mode X X X X
2672monitor fail - X X -
2673monitor-net X X X -
2674monitor-uri X X X -
2675option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2676option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2677option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2678option allbackups (*) X - X X
2679option checkcache (*) X - X X
2680option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2681option contstats (*) X X X -
2682option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2683option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2685option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002686option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2687option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002688option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002689option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002690option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002691option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002692option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2694option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2695option httpchk X - X X
2696option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002697option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002699option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002700option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002701option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2703option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2704option logasap (*) X X X -
2705option mysql-check X - X X
2706option nolinger (*) X X X X
2707option originalto X X X X
2708option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002709option pgsql-check X - X X
2710option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002711option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002712option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002713option smtpchk X - X X
2714option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2715option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2716option splice-request (*) X X X X
2717option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002718option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002719option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2720option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2721-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002722option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2724option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2725option tcpka X X X X
2726option tcplog X X X X
2727option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002728external-check command X - X X
2729external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002730persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2731rate-limit sessions X X X -
2732redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002735retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002737server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002738server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002740stats admin - X X X
2741stats auth X X X X
2742stats enable X X X X
2743stats hide-version X X X X
2744stats http-request - X X X
2745stats realm X X X X
2746stats refresh X X X X
2747stats scope X X X X
2748stats show-desc X X X X
2749stats show-legends X X X X
2750stats show-node X X X X
2751stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002752-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2753stick match - - X X
2754stick on - - X X
2755stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002756stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002757stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002758tcp-check connect - - X X
2759tcp-check expect - - X X
2760tcp-check send - - X X
2761tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002762tcp-request connection - X X -
2763tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002764tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002765tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002766tcp-response content - - X X
2767tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002768timeout check X - X X
2769timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002770timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002771timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002772timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2773timeout http-request X X X X
2774timeout queue X - X X
2775timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002776timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002778timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002780unique-id-format X X X -
2781unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002782use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002783use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002784use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2786 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027894.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2790---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
2792This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2793
2794
2795acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2796 Declare or complete an access list.
2797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2798 no | yes | yes | yes
2799 Example:
2800 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2801 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2802 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002804 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805
2806
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002807backlog <conns>
2808 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments :
2812 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2813 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002814 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815
2816 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2817 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2818 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2819 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2820 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2821 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2822 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2823 backlog parameter.
2824
2825 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2826 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2827 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2828
2829 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2830
2831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002833balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 yes | no | yes | yes
2837 Arguments :
2838 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2839 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2840 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2841 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2842
2843 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2844 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2845 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2846 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002847 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002848 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002849 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2850 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2851 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2852 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2853 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2854 it, so that you don't worry.
2855
2856 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2857 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2858 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2859 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2860 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2861 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2862 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2863 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002865 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2866 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2867 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2868 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2869 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2870 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2871 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2872 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2873
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002874 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002875 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002876 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2877 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002878 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002879 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2880 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2881 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2882 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2883 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002884 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2885 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2886 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2887 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2888 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2889 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2892 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2893 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2894 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2895 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2896 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2897 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2898 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002899 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002901 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2902 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2903 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002905 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2906 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2907 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2908 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2909 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2910 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2911 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2912 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2913 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2914 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2915 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2916 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002918 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002919 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2920 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2921 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2922 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2923 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2924 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2925 URIs start with a leading "/".
2926
2927 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2928 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2929 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2930 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002933 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2934
2935 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002936 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2937 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002938 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2939 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2940 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2941 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002942 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002943 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2944 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002945
2946 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2947 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2948 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2949 server will receive the request.
2950
2951 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2952 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2953 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2954 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2955 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002956 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2957 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2958 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2961 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2962 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2963 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2964 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002966 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002967 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2968 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2969 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2970
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002971 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2972 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2973 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2974
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002975 random
2976 random(<draws>)
2977 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002978 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2979 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2980 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2981 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002982 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2983 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2984 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2985 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2986 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2987 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2988 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2989 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2990 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2991 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2992 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2993 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2994 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2995 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2996 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2997 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2998 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2999 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3000 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3001 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003002
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003003 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003004 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003005 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3006 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3007 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3008 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3009 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3010 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003011 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003012 used instead.
3013
3014 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3015 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3016 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3017 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3018
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003019 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3020 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3021 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3022
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003023 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003025 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003026 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3027 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003028
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003029 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3030 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3031 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003033 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003035 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3036 NTLM relies on.
3037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 Examples :
3039 balance roundrobin
3040 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003041 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003042 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3043 balance hdr(host)
3044 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003045
3046 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3047 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003049 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003050 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3051 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3052 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003053 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003054
3055 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3056 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3057 defaults to 16 kB.
3058
3059 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3060 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3061
3062 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3063 Round Robin.
3064
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003065 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003066 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3067 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3068 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3069
3070 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3071
3072 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003073 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3075 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3076 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003078 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003081bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3082bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003087 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3088 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3089 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3090 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003091 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003092 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3093 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3094 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3095 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3096 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3097 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3098 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003099 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3100 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3101 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3102 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3103 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3104 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3105 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003106 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3107 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3108 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003109 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3110 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3111 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3112 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003113 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3114 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3115 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003116
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003117 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3118 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003119 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3120 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3121 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003122 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3123 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3124 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3125 the range.
3126
3127 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3128 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3129 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3130 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3131 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3132 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3133 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003134 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003135 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003137 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003138 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003139 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3140 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3141 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3142 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3143 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3144 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003146 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3147 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3148 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3149 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3152 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3153 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3154 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3155 in a frontend.
3156
3157 Example :
3158 listen http_proxy
3159 bind :80,:443
3160 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003161 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003163 listen http_https_proxy
3164 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003165 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003166
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003167 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3168 bind ipv6@:80
3169 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3170 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3171
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003172 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003173 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003174
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003175 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3176 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3177 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3178 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3179 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3180
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003181 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003182 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
3184
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003185bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003186 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | yes | yes | yes
3189 Arguments :
3190 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3191 may be used to override a default value.
3192
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003193 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 option may be combined with other numbers.
3195
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003196 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3198 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3199 missing from all processes.
3200
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003201 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003202 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003203 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3204 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3205 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3206 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3207 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003208 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003209
3210 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3211 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3212 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3213 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3214 and 'even' instances.
3215
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003216 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3217 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3218 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3219 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003221 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3222 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3223
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003224 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3225 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3226 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3227
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3229 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3230
3231 Example :
3232 listen app_ip1
3233 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003234 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003235
3236 listen app_ip2
3237 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003238 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003239
3240 listen management
3241 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003244 listen management
3245 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3246 bind-process 1-4
3247
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003248 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003249
3250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251capture cookie <name> len <length>
3252 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 no | yes | yes | no
3255 Arguments :
3256 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3257 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3258 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3259 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261
3262 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3263 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3264 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3265 right if it exceeds <length>.
3266
3267 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3268 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3269 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3270 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3271
3272 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3273 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3274 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3275
3276 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3277 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3278 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003279 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3280 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3281 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003282
3283 Example:
3284 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3285
3286 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288
3289
3290capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003291 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 no | yes | yes | no
3294 Arguments :
3295 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003296 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3298 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3299 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3300
3301 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3302 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3303 it exceeds <length>.
3304
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003305 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3307 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003308 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3309 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3310 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3311 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003312 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003313 environments to find where the request came from.
3314
3315 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3316 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3317 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3318 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003320 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3321 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3322 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3323 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3324 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325
3326 Example:
3327 capture request header Host len 15
3328 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003329 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003331 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 about logging.
3333
3334
3335capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003336 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3338 no | yes | yes | no
3339 Arguments :
3340 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003341 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003342 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3343 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3344 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3345
3346 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3347 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3348 it exceeds <length>.
3349
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003350 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3352 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3353 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003354 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3355 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3356 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3357 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003359 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3360 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3361 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3362 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3363 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
3365 Example:
3366 capture response header Content-length len 9
3367 capture response header Location len 15
3368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003369 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370 about logging.
3371
3372
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003373compression algo <algorithm> ...
3374compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003375compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003376 Enable HTTP compression.
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 yes | yes | yes | yes
3379 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003380 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3381 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3382 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3383
3384 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003385 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3386 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3387 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003389 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003390 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003391
3392 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3393 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3394 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3395 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3396 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003397 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003398
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3400 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3401 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3402 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3403 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3404 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3405 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003406 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003407
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003408 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003409 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003410 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3411 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3412 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3413 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3414 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003415
3416 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3417 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3418 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3419 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3420 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003421 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3422 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3423 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3424 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3425 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003426 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3427 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003428
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003429 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003430 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3431 "Accept-Encoding" header
3432 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003433 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003434 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3435 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3436 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3437 "multipart"
3438 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3439 header
3440 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3441 and later
3442 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3443 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003444 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003445
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003446 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003447
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003448 Examples :
3449 compression algo gzip
3450 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003453cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003454 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3455 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003456 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | no | yes | yes
3460 Arguments :
3461 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3462 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3463 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3464 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3465 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3466 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003467 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3469 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3470
3471 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3472 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3473 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3474 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3475 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3476 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003477 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3478 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003479 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003480 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3481 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
3483 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003484 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003485
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003486 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003487 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003488 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003489 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003490 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3491 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3492 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3493 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3494 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3495 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3496 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003497
3498 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3499 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3500 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3501 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3502 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3503 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3504 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3505 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3506 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003507 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003508 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3509 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3510 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003512 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3513 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3514 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003515 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3516 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3517 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3518 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003519 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3520 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3521 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
3523 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3524 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3525 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3526 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3527 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3528 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3529 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3530 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3531 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3532
3533 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3534 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3535 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3536 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3537 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3538 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3539 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3540 persistence cookie in the cache.
3541 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3542
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003543 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3544 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3545 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3546 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3547 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003549 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3550 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3551 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3552 they logout.
3553
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003554 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3555 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3556 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3557 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3558
3559 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3560 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3561 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3562 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3563 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3564 this attribute.
3565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003566 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003567 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003568 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3569 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3570 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3571 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3572 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3573 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003575 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3576 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3577 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3578 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3579 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3580 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3581 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3582 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003584 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3585 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3586 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3587 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3588 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3589 the site.
3590
3591 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3592 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3593 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3594 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3595 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3596 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3597 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3598 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3599 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3600 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3601 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3602 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3603 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003604 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003605 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3606 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3607
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003608 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3609 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3610 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3611 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3612 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3613 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3614
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003615 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3616 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3617 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3618 repeated.
3619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3621 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3622 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3623 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003624
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 Examples :
3626 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3627 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3628 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003629 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003631 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003633
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003634declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3635 Declares a capture slot.
3636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 no | yes | yes | no
3638 Arguments:
3639 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3640
3641 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3642 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3643 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3644 for use in the response.
3645
3646 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003647 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003648 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3649
3650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003651default-server [param*]
3652 Change default options for a server in a backend
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | no | yes | yes
3655 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003656 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3657 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3658 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3659 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003660
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003661 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003662 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3663
3664 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003665
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667default_backend <backend>
3668 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | no
3671 Arguments :
3672 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3673
3674 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3675 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3676 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3677 will catch all undetermined requests.
3678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679 Example :
3680
3681 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3682 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3683 default_backend dynamic
3684
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003685 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003688description <string>
3689 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 no | yes | yes | yes
3692 Arguments : string
3693
3694 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3695 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3696 it describes.
3697 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3698
3699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700disabled
3701 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3703 yes | yes | yes | yes
3704 Arguments : none
3705
3706 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3707 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3708 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3709 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3710 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3711 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3712 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3713
3714 See also : "enabled"
3715
3716
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003717dispatch <address>:<port>
3718 Set a default server address
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003721 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003722
3723 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3724 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3725 during start-up.
3726
3727 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3728 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3729 possible with normal servers.
3730
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003731 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003732 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3733 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3734 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3735 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3736
3737 See also : "server"
3738
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003739
3740dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3741 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3743 yes | no | yes | yes
3744 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3745
3746 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003748 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3749 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003751 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753enabled
3754 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | yes
3757 Arguments : none
3758
3759 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3760 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3761
3762 See also : "disabled"
3763
3764
3765errorfile <code> <file>
3766 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 yes | yes | yes | yes
3769 Arguments :
3770 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003771 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3772 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773
3774 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003775 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003777 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3778 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
3780 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3781 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3782 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3783
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003784 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3787 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3788 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3789 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3790
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003791 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3792 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003793 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003794 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3795 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3796 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3799 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3800 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003801 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3803
3804 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3805
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003806 Example :
3807 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003808 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003809 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3810 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003812
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003813errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3814 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3815 section.
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | yes | yes | yes
3818 Arguments :
3819 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3820
3821 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3822 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3823 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3824
3825 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3826 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3827 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3828 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3829 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3830 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3831 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3832
3833 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3834 3.8 about http-errors.
3835
3836 Example :
3837 errorfiles generic
3838 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3839
3840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003841errorloc <code> <url>
3842errorloc302 <code> <url>
3843 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | yes | yes | yes
3846 Arguments :
3847 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003848 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3849 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850
3851 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3852 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3853 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3854 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003855 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856
3857 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3858 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3859 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3860
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003861 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3864 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3865 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3866 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003867 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003868 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3869 request.
3870
3871 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3872
3873
3874errorloc303 <code> <url>
3875 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | yes | yes | yes
3878 Arguments :
3879 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003880 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3881 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003882
3883 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3884 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3885 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3886 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003887 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888
3889 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3890 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3891 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3892
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003893 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3894
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003895 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3896 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3897 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3898 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003899 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003900
3901 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3902
3903
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003904email-alert from <emailaddr>
3905 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003906 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | yes
3909
3910 Arguments :
3911
3912 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3913
3914 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3915 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3916
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003917 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003918 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3919 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920
3921
3922email-alert level <level>
3923 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3924 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | yes | yes | yes
3927
3928 Arguments :
3929
3930 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3931 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3932 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3933
3934 By default level is alert
3935
3936 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3937 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3938 for the proxy.
3939
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003940 Alerts are sent when :
3941
3942 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3943 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3944 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3945 is notice or lower
3946 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3947 and a health check status update occurs
3948
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003949 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3950 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003951 section 3.6 about mailers.
3952
3953
3954email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3955 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3957 yes | yes | yes | yes
3958
3959 Arguments :
3960
3961 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3962
3963 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3964 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3965
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003966 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3967 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003968
3969
3970email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3971 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3972 mailers.
3973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3974 yes | yes | yes | yes
3975
3976 Arguments :
3977
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003978 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003979
3980 By default the systems hostname is used.
3981
3982 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3983 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3984 for the proxy.
3985
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003986 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3987 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003988
3989
3990email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003991 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003992 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | yes
3995
3996 Arguments :
3997
3998 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3999
4000 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4001 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4002
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004003 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004004 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4005
4006
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004007force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4008 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004010 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004011
4012 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4013 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4014 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4015 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4016 marked down for maintenance operations.
4017
4018 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4019 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4020 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4021 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4022 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4023 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4024 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4025 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4026 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4027
4028 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4029 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4030 is used.
4031
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004032 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004033 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004034
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004035
4036filter <name> [param*]
4037 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 no | yes | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4042 referenced in section 9.
4043
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004044 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004045 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004046 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4047 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004048
4049 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4050 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4051
4052 Example:
4053 listen
4054 bind *:80
4055
4056 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4057 filter compression
4058 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4059
4060 compression algo gzip
4061 compression offload
4062
4063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4064
4065 See also : section 9.
4066
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004067
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004068fullconn <conns>
4069 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | no | yes | yes
4072 Arguments :
4073 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4074 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4075
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004076 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004078 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004079 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4080 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4081 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4082 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4083 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004084 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004086 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4087 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004088 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4089 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4090 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092 Example :
4093 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4094 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4095 # connections.
4096 backend dynamic
4097 fullconn 10000
4098 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4099 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4100
4101 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4102
4103
4104grace <time>
4105 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004108 Arguments :
4109 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4110 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4111 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4112
4113 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4114 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004115 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4117
4118 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4119 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4120 simplify it.
4121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004123hash-balance-factor <factor>
4124 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | no | no | yes
4127 Arguments :
4128 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4129 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004130 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131
4132 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4133 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4134 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4135 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4136 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4137 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4138 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4139
4140 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4141 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4142 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4143 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4144 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4145
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004146 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4147 consistent hashing mechanism.
4148
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004149 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4150
4151
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004152hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004153 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4155 yes | no | yes | yes
4156 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004157 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4158 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004159
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004160 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4161 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4162 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4163 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4164 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4165 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4166 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4167 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4168 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4169 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004170
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004171 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4172 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4173 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4174 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4175 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4176 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4177 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4178 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4179 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4180 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4181 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4182 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4183 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004184 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4185 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004186
4187 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4188
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004189 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004190 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4191 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4192 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004193 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4194 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4195 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004196
4197 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4198 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004199 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4200 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4201 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4202 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4203
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004204 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4205 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4206 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4207 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4208 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4209 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4210 parameter.
4211
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004212 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4213 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4214 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4215 used on strings.
4216
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004217 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4218
4219 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4220 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4221 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4222 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4223 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4224 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4225 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4226 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4227 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4228 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4229 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4230 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004231
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004232 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4233 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4234 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004235
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004236 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004237
4238
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004239http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4240 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4241 ones).
4242
4243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | yes
4245
4246 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4247 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4248 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4249 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4250 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4251 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4252
4253 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4254 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4255 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4256
4257 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4258 below.
4259
4260 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4261 instance.
4262
4263 Example:
4264 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4265 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4266 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4267
4268http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4269
4270 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4271 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4272 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4273 example, or to pass some internal information.
4274 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4275 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4276 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4277
4278http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4281 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4282
4283http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4284
4285 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4286
4287http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4289
4290 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4291
4292 Example:
4293 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4294
4295 # applied to:
4296 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4297
4298 # outputs:
4299 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4300
4301 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4302
4303http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4304 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4305
4306 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4307
4308 Example:
4309 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4310
4311 # applied to:
4312 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4313
4314 # outputs:
4315 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4316
4317http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4318
4319 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4320 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4321 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4322
4323http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4325
4326 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4327 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4328 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4329 fallback.
4330
4331 Example:
4332 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4333 http-response set-status 431
4334 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4335 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4336
4337http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4338
4339 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4340 inline.
4341
4342 Arguments:
4343 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4344 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4345 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4346 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4347 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4348 (request and response)
4349 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4350 processing
4351 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4352 processing
4353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4354 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4355 and '_'.
4356
4357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4358 followed by some converters.
4359
4360 Example:
4361 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4362
4363http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4364
4365 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4366 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4367 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4368 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4369 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004370 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004371 processing.
4372
4373 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4374 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4375 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4376 rules evaluation.
4377
4378http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4379
4380 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4381 details about <var-name>.
4382
4383 Example:
4384 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4385
4386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004387http-check disable-on-404
4388 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004390 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391 Arguments : none
4392
4393 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4394 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4395 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4396 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4397 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4398 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4399 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4400 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004401 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4402 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4403 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4404
4405 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4406
4407
4408http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004409 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004411 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004412 Arguments :
4413 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4414 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004415 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004416 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4417 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4418 details on the supported keywords.
4419
4420 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4421 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4422 with the usual backslash ('\').
4423
4424 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4425 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4426 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4427 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4428 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4429
4430 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004431 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004432 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4433 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4434 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4435
4436 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004437 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004438 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4439 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4440 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4441 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4442
4443 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004444 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004445 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4446 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4447 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4448 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4449 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004450 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004451 trace).
4452
4453 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004454 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004455 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4456 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4457 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4458 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4459 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004460 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004461
4462 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4463 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4464 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4465 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4466 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4467 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4468 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4469 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4470
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004471 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4472 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4473 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4474
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004475 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4476 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4477
4478 Examples :
4479 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004480 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004481
4482 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004483 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004484
4485 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004486 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004487
4488 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004489 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004491 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492
4493
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004494http-check send-state
4495 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | no | yes | yes
4498 Arguments : none
4499
4500 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4501 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4502 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4503 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4504 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4505
4506 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4507 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4508 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4509 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4510 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004511 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4512 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4513 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4514
4515 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4516 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4517 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4518
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004519 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4520 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4521 checked in multiple backends.
4522
4523 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4524 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4525
4526 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4527 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4528 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4529 one fails.
4530
4531 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4532 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4533 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4534
4535 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4536 server's queue.
4537
4538 Example of a header received by the application server :
4539 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4540 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4541
4542 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544
4545http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004546 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4547
4548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4549 no | yes | yes | yes
4550
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004551 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4552 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4553 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4554 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4555 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4558 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 Example:
4563 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4564 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4565 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567 http-request allow if nagios
4568 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4569 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4570 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004572 Example:
4573 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4574 acl add path /addacl
4575 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4580 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 Example:
4583 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4584 acl setmap path /setmap
4585 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4590 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4593 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4598 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4599 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4600 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4601 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4602 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4603 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4604 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4609 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4610 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4611 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4612 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4613 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4614 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4615 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4620 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004621
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4626 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4627 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4628 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4629 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 Example:
4632 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4633 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004635http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004636
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004637 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4643 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4644 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4645 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4646 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4647 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4648 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4649 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4650 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4653 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4654 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004655 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4656
4657 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4658 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4659 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4660 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4665 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4666 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4667 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4668 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4669 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4678 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4679 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4680 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4681 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4682 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004683
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004684http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4685 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4688 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4689 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004690 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4691 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4692 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4693 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4694 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004695 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004696
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004697http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4698 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4699 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4700 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4701
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004702http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4703
4704 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4705 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4706 pointed by <resolvers>.
4707 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4708 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4709 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4710 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4711 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4712 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4713 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4714 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4715 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4716 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4717 to 0.0.0.0.
4718
4719 Example:
4720 resolvers mydns
4721 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4722 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4723 timeout retry 1s
4724 hold valid 10s
4725 hold nx 3s
4726 hold other 3s
4727 hold obsolete 0s
4728 accepted_payload_size 8192
4729
4730 frontend fe
4731 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4732 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4733 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4734
4735 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4736 # which mean DNS resolution error
4737 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4738
4739 default_backend be
4740
4741 backend b_503
4742 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4743 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4744 # 503 error page to end users
4745
4746 backend be
4747 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4748 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4749 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4750 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4751 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4752
4753 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4754 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4755
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004756http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4757
4758 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4759 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4760 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4761 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004762 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4763 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004764
4765 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4770 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4771 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4772 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4773 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004775http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004777 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4778 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4779 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4780 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004782http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4783 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004784
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004785 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004786 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4787 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4788 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4789 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4790 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004791
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004792 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4793 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4794 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4795 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4796 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004797
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004798 Example:
4799 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4800
4801 # applied to:
4802 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4803
4804 # outputs:
4805 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4806
4807 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004808
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004809 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4810
4811 # applied to:
4812 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004813
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004814 # outputs:
4815 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004816
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004817http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4819
4820 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4821 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4822 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4823 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4824
4825 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4826 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4827 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4828
4829 Example:
4830 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4831 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4832
4833 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4834 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4835
4836 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4837 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4838 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4839 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4840
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004841http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4842 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4843
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004844 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4845 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4846 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4847 against.
4848
4849 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4850 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4851 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004852
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004853 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4854 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4855 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4856 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4857 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4858 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4859 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4860 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4861 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004862 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4863 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004864
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004865 Example:
4866 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4867 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004868
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004869 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4870 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004872http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4873 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004874
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004875 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4876 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4877 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4878 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004879
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004880 Example:
4881 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004882
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004883 # applied to:
4884 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004885
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004886 # outputs:
4887 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004888
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004889http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4890 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4891 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004892 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004893 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4894
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004895 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004896 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4897 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4898 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4899 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004900 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004901 are followed to create the response :
4902
4903 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4904 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4905 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4906 ignored.
4907
4908 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4909 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4910 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4911 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4912 ignored.
4913
4914 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4915 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4916 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4917 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4918 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4919
4920 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4921 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4922 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4923 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4924 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4925 if any, is ignored.
4926
4927 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4928 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4929 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4930 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4931 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4932 as a raw content.
4933
4934 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4935 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4936 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4937 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4938 considered as a raw string.
4939
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004940 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4941 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4942 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4943 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4944
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004945 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4946 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4947 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4948
4949 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4950
4951 Example:
4952 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4953 if { path /ping }
4954
4955 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4956 if { path /favicon.ico }
4957
4958 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4959 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4960 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004962http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4963http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004965 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4966 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4967 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004968
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004969http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4970 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004971
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004972 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4973 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4974 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4975 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004977http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004979 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4980 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4981 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4982 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4983 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004985 Arguments:
4986 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4987 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989 Example:
4990 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4991 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004993 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4994 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004998 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4999 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5000 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005002 Arguments:
5003 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5004 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006 Example:
5007 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5008 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005010 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5011 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5012 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005016 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5017 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5018 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5019 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5020 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005022 Example:
5023 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5024 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5025 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5026 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5027 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5031 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005033http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005035 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5036 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5037 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5038 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5039 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005041http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5042 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5045 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5046 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5047 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5048 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5049 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5050 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5051 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5052 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005054http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005056 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5057 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5058 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5059 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5060 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5061 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5062 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005066 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5067 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5068 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005070http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005072 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5073 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5074 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5075 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5076 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5077 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5078 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5079 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5084 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5085 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5086 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5087 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5088 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005090 Example :
5091 # prepend the host name before the path
5092 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5097 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5098 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5099 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5100 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005102http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005104 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5105 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5106 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5107 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5108 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5109 values have higher priority.
5110 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5111 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5112 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5113 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5114 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005116http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005118 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5119 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5120 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5121 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5122 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5123 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5124 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005126 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005127
5128 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005129 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5130 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005132http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5133 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5134 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5135 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005136 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5137 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138
5139 Arguments :
5140 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5141 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005142
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005143 See also "option forwardfor".
5144
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005145 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005146 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5147 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5148
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005149 # After the masking this will track connections
5150 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5151 http-request track-sc0 src
5152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005153 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5154 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5155
5156http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5157
5158 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5159 expression.
5160
5161 Arguments:
5162 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5163 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005164
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005165 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005166 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5167 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5168
5169 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5170 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5171 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5172
5173http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5174
5175 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5176 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5177 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5178 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5179 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5180 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5181 information from the request.
5182
5183 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5184
5185http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5186
5187 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5188 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5189 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5190 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5191 path and the query string.
5192 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5193
5194http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5195
5196 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5197 inline.
5198
5199 Arguments:
5200 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5201 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5202 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5203 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5204 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5205 (request and response)
5206 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5207 processing
5208 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5209 processing
5210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5211 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5212 and '_'.
5213
5214 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5215 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005216
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005217 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005218 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005220http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5221 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005223 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5224 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5225 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5226 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5227 agent name must be used.
5228
5229 Arguments:
5230 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5231
5232 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5233 configuration.
5234
5235http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5238 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5239 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5240 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5241 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5242 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5243 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5244 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5245 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5246 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5247 action.
5248 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5249 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5250 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5251 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5252 you fully understand how it works.
5253
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005254http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5255
5256 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5257 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5258 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5259 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5260 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005261 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005262 processing.
5263
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005264 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005265 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5266 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5267 rules evaluation.
5268
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005269http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005271
5272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5273 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5274 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5275 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5276 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5277 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5278 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5279 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5280 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5281 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5282 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005283 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5284 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5285 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5286 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5287 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005288 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5289
5290http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5291http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5292http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5293
5294 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5295 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5296 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5297 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5298 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5299 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5300 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5301 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5302 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5303 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5304 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5305 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5306
5307 Arguments :
5308 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5309 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5310 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5311 select which table entry to update the counters.
5312
5313 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5314 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5315 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5316 that table until the session ends.
5317
5318 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5319 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5320 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5321 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5322 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5323 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5324 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5325 useful information.
5326
5327 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5328 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5329 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5330 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5331 checks that make use of it.
5332
5333http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5334
5335 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005336
5337 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005338 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005339
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005340http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5341
5342 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5343 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5344 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5345 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5346 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5347 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5348
5349 Arguments :
5350 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5351
5352 Example:
5353 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005355http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5358 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5359 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005360
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005362http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005363 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5364
5365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 no | yes | yes | yes
5367
5368 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5369 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5370 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5371 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5372 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5373 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5374
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005375 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5376 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005378 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005380 Example:
5381 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005383 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005384
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005385 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5386 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005388 Example:
5389 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005391 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005392
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005393 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5394 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005395
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005396 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5397 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005398
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005399http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005400
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005401 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5402 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5403 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5404 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5405 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5406 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5407 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5408 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005410http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005412 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5413 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5414 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5415 example, or to pass some internal information.
5416 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5417 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5418 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005420http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005422 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5423 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005424
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005425http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005426
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005427 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005429http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005431 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5432 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5433 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5434 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5435 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5436 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5437 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005439 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5440 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5441 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5442 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5443 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005444
5445 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5446 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5447 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5448 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005450http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005452 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5453 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5454 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5455 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5456 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5457 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005459http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005462
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005463http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005465 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5466 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5467 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5468 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5469 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5470 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005471
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005472http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005474
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005475 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005476 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5477 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005478 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5479 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5480 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5481 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5482 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005483 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005485http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005487 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5488 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5489 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5490 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5491 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5492 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005493
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005494http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005496
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005497 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5498 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005500 Example:
5501 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005503 # applied to:
5504 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005505
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005506 # outputs:
5507 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005508
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005509 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005510
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005511http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5512 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005513
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005514 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005515 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005516
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005517 Example:
5518 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005520 # applied to:
5521 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005522
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005523 # outputs:
5524 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005525
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005526http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5527 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5528 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005529 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5531
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005532 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005533 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5534 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5535 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5536 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005537 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005538 are followed to create the response :
5539
5540 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5541 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5542 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5543 ignored.
5544
5545 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5546 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5547 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5548 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5549 ignored.
5550
5551 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5552 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5553 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5554 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5555 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5556
5557 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5558 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5559 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5560 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5561 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5562 if any, is ignored.
5563
5564 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5565 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5566 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5567 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5568 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5569 as a raw content.
5570
5571 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5572 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5573 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5574 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5575 considered as a raw string.
5576
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005577 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5578 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5579 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5580 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5581
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005582 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5583 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5584 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5585
5586 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5587
5588 Example:
5589 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5590 if { status eq 404 }
5591
5592 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5593 string "This is the end !" \
5594 if { status eq 500 }
5595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005596http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5597http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005599 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5600 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5601 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005602
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005603http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5604 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005605
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005606 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5607 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5608 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5609 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005610
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005611http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005613 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5614 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5615 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5616 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5617 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005619 Arguments:
5620 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005622 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5623 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005624
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005625http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005627 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5628 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5629 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005631http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5632
5633 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5634 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5635 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5636 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5637 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5638
5639http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5640
5641 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5642 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5643 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5644 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5645 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5646 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5647 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5648 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5649 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5650
5651http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5652
5653 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5654 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5655 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5656 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5657 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5658 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5659 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5660
5661http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5662
5663 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5664 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5665 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5666 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5667 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5668 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5669 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5670 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5671
5672http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5673 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5674
5675 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5676 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5677 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5678 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005679
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005680 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005681 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5682 http-response set-status 431
5683 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5684 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005686http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005688 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5689 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5690 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5691 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5692 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5693 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5694 based on some information from the request.
5695
5696 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5697
5698http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5699
5700 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5701 inline.
5702
5703 Arguments:
5704 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5705 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5706 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5707 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5708 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5709 (request and response)
5710 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5711 processing
5712 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5713 processing
5714 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5715 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5716 and '_'.
5717
5718 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5719 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005720
5721 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005722 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005724http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005725
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005726 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5727 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5728 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5729 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5730 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5731 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5732 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5733 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5734 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5735 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5736 action.
5737 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5738 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5739 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5740 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5741 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005742
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005743http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5744
5745 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5746 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5747 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5748 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5749 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005750 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005751 processing.
5752
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005753 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005754 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5755 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5756 rules evaluation.
5757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005758http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5759http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5760http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005762 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5763 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5764 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5765 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5766 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5767 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5768
5769http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5770
5771 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5772 about <var-name>.
5773
5774 Example:
5775 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5776
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005777
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005778http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5779 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5780
5781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | no | yes | yes
5783
5784 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005785 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5786 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5787 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005788
5789 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5790
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005791 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5792 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5793 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5794 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5795 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5796 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5797 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5798 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5799 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5800 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005801
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005802 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5803 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5804 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5805 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5806 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5807 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5808 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5809 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005810
5811 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5812 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5813 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5814 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5815 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5816 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5817 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5818 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005819 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005820 downsides of rare connection failures.
5821
5822 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5823 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5824 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5825 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5826 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5827 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005828 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005829 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5830 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5831 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5832 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5833 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5834
5835 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005836 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5837 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5838 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005839
5840 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005841 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005842
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005843 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5844 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005845
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005846 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005847
5848 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5849 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5850 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5851
5852 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5853
5854
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005855http-send-name-header [<header>]
5856 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005859 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005860 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5861
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005862 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5863 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5864 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5865 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5866 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5867 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5868 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5869 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5870 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5871 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5872 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5873 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5874 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5875 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5876 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5877 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005878
5879 See also : "server"
5880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005881id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005882 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 no | yes | yes | yes
5885 Arguments : none
5886
5887 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5888 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5889 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005890
5891
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005892ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5893 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005895 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005896
5897 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5898 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5899 and running).
5900
5901 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5902 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5903 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005904 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005905 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5906
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005907 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5908 "unless" condition is met.
5909
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005910 Example:
5911 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5912 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5913 ignore-persist if url_static
5914
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005915 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5916
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005917load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5918 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | no | yes | yes
5921
5922 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5923 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5924 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005925 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005926 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5927 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5928 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5929 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005931 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005932 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005933 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005934
5935 Arguments:
5936 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5937 named "server-state-file".
5938
5939 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5940 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5941 name is used as a file name.
5942
5943 none don't load any stat for this backend
5944
5945 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005946 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5947 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5948 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005949 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005950 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005951
5952 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5953 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5954
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005955 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005956
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005957 global
5958 stats socket /tmp/socket
5959 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005960
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005961 defaults
5962 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005963
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005964 backend bk
5965 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5966 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005967
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005968
5969 Then one can run :
5970
5971 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5972
5973 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5974
5975 1
5976 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5977 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5978 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5979
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005980 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005981
5982 global
5983 stats socket /tmp/socket
5984 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5985
5986 defaults
5987 load-server-state-from-file local
5988
5989 backend bk
5990 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5991 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5992
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005993
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005994 Then one can run :
5995
5996 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5997
5998 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5999
6000 1
6001 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6002 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6003 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6004
6005 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6006 "show servers state"
6007
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006009log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006010log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6011 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006012no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006013 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006016
6017 Prefix :
6018 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6019 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6020 prefix does not allow arguments.
6021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006022 Arguments :
6023 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6024 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6025 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6026 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6027 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6028 parameter.
6029
6030 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6031 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6032
6033 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6034 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6035 standard syslog port).
6036
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006037 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6038 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6039 standard syslog port).
6040
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006041 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6042 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6043 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006044 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006045
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006046 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6047 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6048 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6049 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6050 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6051 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6052 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6053 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6054 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6055 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6056 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6057 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6058 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6059 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6060 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6061 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006062 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6063 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006064
6065 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6066 and "fd@2", see above.
6067
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006068 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6069 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6070 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6071 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6072 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6073 having the logs instantly available.
6074
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006075 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6076 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006077
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006078 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6079 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6080 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6081 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6082 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6083 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6084 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6085 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6086 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6087 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006088 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006089
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006090 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6091 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6092 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6093 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6094 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6095
6096 <sample_size>
6097 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6098 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6099 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6100 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6101 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6102
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006103 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6104 one of the following :
6105
6106 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6107 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6108
6109 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6110 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6111
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006112 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6113 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6114 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6115 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6116 systemd logger consumes.
6117
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006118 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6119 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6120 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6121 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006123 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6124
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006125 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6126 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6127 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6128
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006129 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6130 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6131 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6132 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006133
6134 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6135 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6136 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006137 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6138 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6139 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6140 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6141 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006142
6143 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6144
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006145 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6146 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6147 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006148
6149 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6150 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6151 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6152 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6153
6154 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6155 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006156
6157 Example :
6158 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006159 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6160 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6161 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006162 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6163 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006164 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006165
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006167log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006168 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6170 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006171
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006172 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6173 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6174 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6175 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6176 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006177
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006178 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6179 "option httplog" directives.
6180
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006181log-format-sd <string>
6182 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 yes | yes | yes | no
6185
6186 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6187 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6188 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6189 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6190 which covers the log format string in depth.
6191
6192 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6193 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6194
6195 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6196 log format to "rfc5424".
6197
6198 Example :
6199 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6200
6201
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006202log-tag <string>
6203 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6205 yes | yes | yes | yes
6206
6207 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6208 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6209 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6210 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6211 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6212 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6213 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6214 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6215 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006216
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006217max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6218 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | no | yes | yes
6221
6222 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6223 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6224 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6225 servers.
6226
6227 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6228 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6229 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6230 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6231 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006232 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006233 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6234 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6235 picking a different server.
6236
6237 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6238 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6239 even if they have to be queued.
6240
6241 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6242 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6243
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006244max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6245 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6246 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6247 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006249maxconn <conns>
6250 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | yes | yes | no
6253 Arguments :
6254 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6255 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6256 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6257 closes.
6258
6259 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6260 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6261 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6262 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006263 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6264 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6265 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6266 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006267
6268 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6269 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6270 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6271
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006272 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6273 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006275 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6276
6277
6278mode { tcp|http|health }
6279 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6281 yes | yes | yes | yes
6282 Arguments :
6283 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6284 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6285 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6286 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6287
6288 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6289 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6290 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6291 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6292 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6293
6294 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006295 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6296 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6297 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6298 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6299 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6300 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6301 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006302
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006303 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6304 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6305 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006306
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006307 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006308 defaults http_instances
6309 mode http
6310
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006311 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006313
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006314monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006315 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6317 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006318 Arguments :
6319 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6320 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006321 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006322 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6323 backend and its backup.
6324
6325 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6326 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6327 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6328 servers in a list of backends.
6329
6330 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6331 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6332 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6333 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6334 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6335 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6336 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006337 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6338 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006339
6340 Example:
6341 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006342 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006343 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6344 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6345 monitor-uri /site_alive
6346 monitor fail if site_dead
6347
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006348 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006349
6350
6351monitor-net <source>
6352 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 yes | yes | yes | no
6355 Arguments :
6356 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6357 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6358 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6359 followed by a mask.
6360
6361 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6362 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006363 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006364 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6365
6366 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6367 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6368 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6369 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006370 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6371 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6372 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006373
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006374 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6375 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6376 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6377 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6378 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6379 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006380
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006381 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6382 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006384 Example :
6385 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6386 frontend www
6387 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6388
6389 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6390
6391
6392monitor-uri <uri>
6393 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | yes | yes | no
6396 Arguments :
6397 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6398 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6399
6400 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6401 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6402 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6403 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6404 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6405 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6406 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6407 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6408
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006409 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006410 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6411 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6412 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6413 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6414 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6415 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006416
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006417 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6418 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6419 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6420 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006422 Example :
6423 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6424 frontend www
6425 mode http
6426 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6427
6428 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006430
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006431option abortonclose
6432no option abortonclose
6433 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6435 yes | no | yes | yes
6436 Arguments : none
6437
6438 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6439 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6440 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6441 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006442 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006443 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6444 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6445 encountered while delivering the response.
6446
6447 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6448 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6449 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6450 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6451 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6452 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006453 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006454 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006455 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006456 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6457 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6458 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006460 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6461 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006462 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6463 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6464 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6465 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6466 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6467 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006468 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006469
6470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6472
6473 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6474
6475
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006476option accept-invalid-http-request
6477no option accept-invalid-http-request
6478 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | yes | yes | no
6481 Arguments : none
6482
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006483 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006484 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006485 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006486 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6487 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6488 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6489 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6490 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006491 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6492 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6493 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6494 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006495 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006496 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006497 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6498 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6499 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006500
6501 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6502 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6503 been confirmed.
6504
6505 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6506 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006507 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6508 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006509 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6510
6511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6513
6514 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6515 stats socket.
6516
6517
6518option accept-invalid-http-response
6519no option accept-invalid-http-response
6520 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6522 yes | no | yes | yes
6523 Arguments : none
6524
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006525 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006526 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006527 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006528 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6529 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6530 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6531 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6532 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006533 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6534 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6535 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006536
6537 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6538 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6539 been confirmed.
6540
6541 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6542 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6543 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6544 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6545
6546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6548
6549 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6550 stats socket.
6551
6552
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006553option allbackups
6554no option allbackups
6555 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6557 yes | no | yes | yes
6558 Arguments : none
6559
6560 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6561 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6562 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6563 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6564 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6565 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6566 order between the backup servers anymore.
6567
6568 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6569 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6570
6571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6573
6574
6575option checkcache
6576no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006577 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6579 yes | no | yes | yes
6580 Arguments : none
6581
6582 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6583 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006584 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006585 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6586 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006587 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006588
6589 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006590 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006591 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006592 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6593 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006594 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006595 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006596 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6597 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006598 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006599 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6600 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006601 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006602 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6603 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6604 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6605 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6606 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6607 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6608 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6609 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6610 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6611
6612 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006613 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6614 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6615 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6616 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006617
6618 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6619 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006620 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006621 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006622
6623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6625
6626
6627option clitcpka
6628no option clitcpka
6629 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | yes | yes | no
6632 Arguments : none
6633
6634 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6635 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006636 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006637 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6638
6639 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6640 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6641 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6642 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6643
6644 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6645 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6646 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6647 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6648 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6649
6650 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6651
6652 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6653 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6654 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6655
6656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6658
6659 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6660
6661
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006662option contstats
6663 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | no
6666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6669 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6670 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6671 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006672 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6673 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6674 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6675 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6676 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006677
6678
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006679option dontlog-normal
6680no option dontlog-normal
6681 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 yes | yes | yes | no
6684 Arguments : none
6685
6686 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6687 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6688 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6689 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6690 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6691 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6692 logged.
6693
6694 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6695 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6696 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006698 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006699 logging.
6700
6701
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006702option dontlognull
6703no option dontlognull
6704 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | yes | yes | no
6707 Arguments : none
6708
6709 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6710 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6711 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6712 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6713 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6714 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006715 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6716 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6717 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006718
6719 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006720 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006721 would not be logged.
6722
6723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6725
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006726 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6727 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006728
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006729
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006730option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006731 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6733 yes | yes | yes | yes
6734 Arguments :
6735 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6736 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006737 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006738 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006739
6740 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6741 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6742 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6743 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6744 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6745 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6746 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006747 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6748 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6749 possible that the client has already brought one.
6750
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006751 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006752 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006753 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006754 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006755 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006756 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006757
6758 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6759 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6760 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6761 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6762 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6763 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6764 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6765
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006766 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6767 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6768 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6769 are under the control of the end-user.
6770
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006771 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006772 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6773 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006774 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6775 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6776 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006778 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006779 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6780 frontend www
6781 mode http
6782 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6783
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006784 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6785 backend www
6786 mode http
6787 option forwardfor header X-Client
6788
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006789 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006790 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006791
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006792
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006793option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6794no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6795 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6797 yes | yes | yes | no
6798 Arguments : none
6799
6800 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6801 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6802 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6803 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6804 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6805 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6806 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6807
6808 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6809 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6810 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6811 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6812 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6813 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6814 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6815 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6816 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6817 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6818
6819 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6820
6821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6823
6824 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6825 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6826
6827
6828option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6829no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6830 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6832 yes | no | yes | yes
6833 Arguments : none
6834
6835 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6836 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6837 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6838 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6839 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6840 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6841 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6842
6843 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6844 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6845 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6846 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6847 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6848 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6849 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6850 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6851 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6852 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6853
6854 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6855
6856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6858
6859 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6860 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6861
6862
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006863option http-buffer-request
6864no option http-buffer-request
6865 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 yes | yes | yes | yes
6868 Arguments : none
6869
6870 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6871 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6872 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6873 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6874 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6875 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006876 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6877 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6878 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6879 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006880
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006881 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006882
6883
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006884option http-ignore-probes
6885no option http-ignore-probes
6886 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6888 yes | yes | yes | no
6889 Arguments : none
6890
6891 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6892 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6893 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6894 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6895 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6896 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6897 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6898 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6899 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006900 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6901 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006902 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6903
6904 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6905 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6906 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6907 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6908 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6909 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6910 are often the only way to detect them.
6911
6912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6914
6915 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6916
6917
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006918option http-keep-alive
6919no option http-keep-alive
6920 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 yes | yes | yes | yes
6923 Arguments : none
6924
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006925 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6926 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006927 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6928 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006929 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6930 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6931 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006932
6933 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6934 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006935 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6936 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6937 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6938 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6939 situations where this option may be useful :
6940
6941 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006942 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006943
6944 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6945 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6946
6947 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6948 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6949 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6950 request.
6951
6952 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6953 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006954 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6955 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6956 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006957
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006958 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6959 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6960 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6961 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6962 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6963 not set.
6964
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006965 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6966 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6967 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006968
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006969 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006970 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006971 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006972
6973
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006974option http-no-delay
6975no option http-no-delay
6976 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6978 yes | yes | yes | yes
6979 Arguments : none
6980
6981 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6982 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6983 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6984 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6985 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6986 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6987 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6988 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6989 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6990 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6991 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6992 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6993 affected.
6994
6995 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6996 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6997 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6998 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6999 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7000 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7001 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7002 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7003 latency environments.
7004
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007005 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7006
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007007
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007008option http-pretend-keepalive
7009no option http-pretend-keepalive
7010 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007012 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007013 Arguments : none
7014
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007015 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007016 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7017 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7018 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7019 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7020 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7021 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7022 consider the response complete.
7023
7024 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7025 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7026 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7027 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007028 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007029 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7030
7031 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7032 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7033 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7034 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7035 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7036 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7037 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7038
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007039 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7040 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7041 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7042 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7043 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7044 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007045
7046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7048
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007049 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007050 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007051
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007052
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007053option http-server-close
7054no option http-server-close
7055 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | yes | yes | yes
7058 Arguments : none
7059
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007060 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7061 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7062 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7063 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007064 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7065 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7066 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7067 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7068 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7069 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7070 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7071 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7072 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7073 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7074 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007075
7076 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7077 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7078 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7079 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007080 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7081 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007082
7083 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7084 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007085 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7086 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7087 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007088
7089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7091
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007092 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7093 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007094
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007095option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007096no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007097 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7099 yes | yes | yes | no
7100 Arguments : none
7101
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007102 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007103 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7104 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7105 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7106 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7107 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7108 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7109
7110 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7111 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007112 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7113 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7114 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007115
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007116 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7117 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7118 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7119 front of an existing proxy.
7120
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007121 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7122
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007123 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007124
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007125option httpchk
7126option httpchk <uri>
7127option httpchk <method> <uri>
7128option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7129 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7134 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7135 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7136 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7137 ones.
7138
7139 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7140 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7141 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7142
7143 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7144 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7145 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
7146 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
7147 after "\r\n" following the version string.
7148
7149 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7150 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7151 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7152 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7153 the lack of any response.
7154
7155 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7156
7157 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7158 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7159 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7160
7161 Examples :
7162 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7163 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7164 backend https_relay
7165 mode tcp
7166 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
7167 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7168
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007169 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7170 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7171 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007172
7173
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007174option httpclose
7175no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007176 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7178 yes | yes | yes | yes
7179 Arguments : none
7180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007181 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7182 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7183 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7184 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007185 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007186
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007187 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7188 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007189 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007190 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7191 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007192
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007193 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7194 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7195 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007196
7197 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7198 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007199 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7200 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7201 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007202
7203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7205
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007206 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007207
7208
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007209option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007210 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007212 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007213 Arguments :
7214 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7215 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7216 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007217 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007218 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007219
7220 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7221 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7222 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7223 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7224 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7225 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7226 ports.
7227
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007228 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7229 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007230
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007231 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007234
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007235
7236option http_proxy
7237no option http_proxy
7238 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 yes | yes | yes | yes
7241 Arguments : none
7242
7243 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7244 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7245 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7246 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7247 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7248
7249 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7250 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007251 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7252 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007253
7254 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7255 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7256
7257 Example :
7258 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7259 backend direct_forward
7260 option httpclose
7261 option http_proxy
7262
7263 See also : "option httpclose"
7264
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007265
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007266option independent-streams
7267no option independent-streams
7268 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | yes
7271 Arguments : none
7272
7273 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7274 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7275 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7276 receive data or not.
7277
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007278 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007279 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7280 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7281 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7282 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7283 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7284 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7285 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7286 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7287 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7288 socket buffers.
7289
7290 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7291 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7292 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7293 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7294 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007296 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007297
7298
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007299option ldap-check
7300 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | no | yes | yes
7303 Arguments : none
7304
7305 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7306 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7307 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7308 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7309
7310 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7311 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7312
7313 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7314 configure it.
7315
7316 Example :
7317 option ldap-check
7318
7319 See also : "option httpchk"
7320
7321
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007322option external-check
7323 Use external processes for server health checks
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | no | yes | yes
7326
7327 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7328 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7329 command".
7330
7331 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7332
7333 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7334
7335
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007336option log-health-checks
7337no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007338 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | no | yes | yes
7341 Arguments : none
7342
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007343 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7344 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7345 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007346
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007347 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7348 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7349 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7350 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7351 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007353 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007354 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007355
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007356 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7357 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7358 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007359
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007360
7361option log-separate-errors
7362no option log-separate-errors
7363 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7365 yes | yes | yes | no
7366 Arguments : none
7367
7368 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7369 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7370 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7371 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7372 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7373 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7374 provides very important information.
7375
7376 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7377 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7378 error logs.
7379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007380 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007381 logging.
7382
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007383
7384option logasap
7385no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007386 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 yes | yes | yes | no
7389 Arguments : none
7390
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007391 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7392 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7393 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7394 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7395
7396 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7397 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7398 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7399 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7400 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7401 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7402 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7403 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7404 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7405 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7406 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007408 Examples :
7409 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7410 mode http
7411 option httplog
7412 option logasap
7413 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7414
7415 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7416 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7417 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7418 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007420 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007421 logging.
7422
7423
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007424option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007425 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7427 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007428 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007429 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7430 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007431 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007432
7433 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7434 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007435 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007436 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7437 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7438 in the MySQL table, like this :
7439
7440 USE mysql;
7441 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7442 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7443
7444 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007445 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007446 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7447 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7448 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7449 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7450 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7451 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7452 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7453
7454 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7455 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007456
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007457 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007458
7459 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7460 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7461 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7462 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007463 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7464 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007465
7466 See also: "option httpchk"
7467
7468
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007469option nolinger
7470no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007471 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007474 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007476 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007477 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7478 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7479 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7480 connections.
7481
7482 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7483 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7484 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7485 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7486 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7487 this too.
7488
7489 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7490 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7491 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7492
7493 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7494 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7495 for servers.
7496
7497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7499
7500
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007501option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7502 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | yes | yes | yes
7505 Arguments :
7506 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7507 matching <network>
7508 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7509 header name.
7510
7511 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7512 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7513 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7514 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7515 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7516 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7517 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7518 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7519 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7520 possible that the client has already brought one.
7521
7522 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7523 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7524 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7525 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7526 header and requires different one.
7527
7528 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7529 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7530 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7531 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7532 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7533 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7534 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7535
7536 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7537 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7538 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7539 both are defined.
7540
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007541 Examples :
7542 # Original Destination address
7543 frontend www
7544 mode http
7545 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7546
7547 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7548 backend www
7549 mode http
7550 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7551
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007552 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007553
7554
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007555option persist
7556no option persist
7557 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7559 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007560 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007561
7562 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7563 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7564 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7565 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7566 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7567 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7568 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7569 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7570 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7571 redirected to another valid server.
7572
7573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7575
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007576 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007577
7578
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007579option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7580 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 yes | no | yes | yes
7583 Arguments :
7584 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7585 PostgreSQL server.
7586
7587 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7588 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7589 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7590 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7591
7592 See also: "option httpchk"
7593
7594
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007595option prefer-last-server
7596no option prefer-last-server
7597 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
7600 Arguments : none
7601
7602 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7603 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7604 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7605 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7606 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7607 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7608 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7609 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7610 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007611 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7612 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007613 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7614 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7615 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007616 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7617 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7618 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007619
7620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7622
7623 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7624
7625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007626option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007627option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007628no option redispatch
7629 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7631 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007632 Arguments :
7633 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7634 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7635 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007636 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007637 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007638 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007639 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7640 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7641 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007643
7644 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7645 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7646 be able to access the service anymore.
7647
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007648 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7649 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007650
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007651 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7652 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7653 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7654 following order:
7655
7656 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7657
7658 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7659 list, or
7660
7661 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7662
7663 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7664 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7665
7666 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7667 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7668 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7669 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7670
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007671 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007672 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7673 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7677
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007678 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007679
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007680
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007681option redis-check
7682 Use redis health checks for server testing
7683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7684 yes | no | yes | yes
7685 Arguments : none
7686
7687 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7688 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7689 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7690 find the "+PONG" response message.
7691
7692 Example :
7693 option redis-check
7694
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007695 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007696
7697
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007698option smtpchk
7699option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7700 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7702 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007703 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007704 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007705 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007706 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7707
7708 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7709 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7710 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7711
7712 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7713 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7714 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7715 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7716 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7717 dead server.
7718
7719 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7720 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007721 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007722 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7723
7724 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7725 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7726 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7727 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007728 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007729
7730 Example :
7731 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7732
7733 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007736option socket-stats
7737no option socket-stats
7738
7739 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7741 yes | yes | yes | no
7742
7743 Arguments : none
7744
7745
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007746option splice-auto
7747no option splice-auto
7748 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | yes | yes | yes
7751 Arguments : none
7752
7753 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7754 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007755 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007756 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007757 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007758 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7759 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7760 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7761 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7762
7763 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7764 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7765 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7766 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7767 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7768 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7769 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7770 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7771 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7772 keyword.
7773
7774 Example :
7775 option splice-auto
7776
7777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7779
7780 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7781 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7782
7783
7784option splice-request
7785no option splice-request
7786 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7788 yes | yes | yes | yes
7789 Arguments : none
7790
7791 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007792 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007793 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7794 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7795 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7796 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7797
7798 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7799
7800 Example :
7801 option splice-request
7802
7803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7805
7806 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7807 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7808
7809
7810option splice-response
7811no option splice-response
7812 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7814 yes | yes | yes | yes
7815 Arguments : none
7816
7817 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007818 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007819 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7820 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7821 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7822 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7823
7824 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7825
7826 Example :
7827 option splice-response
7828
7829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7831
7832 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7833 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7834
7835
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007836option spop-check
7837 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7839 no | no | no | yes
7840 Arguments : none
7841
7842 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7843 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7844 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7845 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7846
7847 Example :
7848 option spop-check
7849
7850 See also : "option httpchk"
7851
7852
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007853option srvtcpka
7854no option srvtcpka
7855 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | no | yes | yes
7858 Arguments : none
7859
7860 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7861 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007862 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007863 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7864
7865 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7866 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7867 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7868 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7869
7870 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7871 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7872 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7873 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7874 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7875
7876 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7877
7878 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7879 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7880 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7881
7882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7884
7885 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7886
7887
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007888option ssl-hello-chk
7889 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | no | yes | yes
7892 Arguments : none
7893
7894 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7895 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7896 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7897 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7898 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7899 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7900 hello message.
7901
7902 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7903 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7904 messages, which is appreciable.
7905
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007906 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7907 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7908 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007909
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007910 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7911
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007912
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007913option tcp-check
7914 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7916 yes | no | yes | yes
7917
7918 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7919 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7920
7921 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7922 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7923 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7924
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007925 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007926 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7927 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7928 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7929 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7930 only.
7931
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007932 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007933 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7934 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7935 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7936 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7937
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007938 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007939 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7940 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007941 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007942 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7943 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7944 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7945 the respective protocols.
7946 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007947 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007948
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007949 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7950 script.
7951
7952 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7953 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7954 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7955 The "comment" is of course optional.
7956
7957
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007958 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007959 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007960 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007961 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007962
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007963 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007964 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007965 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007966
7967 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7968 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007969 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007970 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007971 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007972 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007973 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007974 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007975 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7976 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007977 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007978 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7979 tcp-check expect string +OK
7980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007982 (send many headers before analyzing)
7983 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007984 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007985 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7986 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7987 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7988 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007989 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007990
7991
7992 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7993
7994
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007995option tcp-smart-accept
7996no option tcp-smart-accept
7997 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | yes | yes | no
8000 Arguments : none
8001
8002 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8003 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8004 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8005 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8006 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8007 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8008
8009 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8010 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8011 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8012 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8013
8014 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8015 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8016 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008017 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008018
8019 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8020 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8021 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8022
8023 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8024 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8025 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8026
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008027 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8028
8029
8030option tcp-smart-connect
8031no option tcp-smart-connect
8032 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8034 yes | no | yes | yes
8035 Arguments : none
8036
8037 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8038 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8039 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8040 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8041 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8042
8043 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8044 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8045 complex.
8046
8047 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8048 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8049 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8050
8051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8053
8054 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8055
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008056
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008057option tcpka
8058 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8060 yes | yes | yes | yes
8061 Arguments : none
8062
8063 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8064 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008065 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008066 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8067
8068 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8069 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8070 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8071 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8072
8073 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8074 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8075 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8076 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8077 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8078
8079 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8080
8081 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8082 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8083 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8084 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8085 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8086 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8087 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8088 backends.
8089
8090 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8091
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008092
8093option tcplog
8094 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008096 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008097 Arguments : none
8098
8099 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8100 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8101 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8102 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8103 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8104 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8105 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8106 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8107
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008108 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008110 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008111
8112
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008113option transparent
8114no option transparent
8115 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008117 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008118 Arguments : none
8119
8120 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8121 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8122 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8123 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8124 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8125 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8126 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8127 appropriate server.
8128
8129 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8130 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8131
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008132 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008133 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008134
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008135
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008136external-check command <command>
8137 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | no | yes | yes
8140
8141 Arguments :
8142 <command> is the external command to run
8143
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008144 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8145
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008146 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008147
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008148 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8149 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8150 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8151 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8152 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8153 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008154
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008155 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8156
8157 Environment variables :
8158 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8159 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8160
8161 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8162
8163 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8164
8165 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8166 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8167 for a UNIX socket).
8168
8169 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8170
8171 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8172
8173 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8174
8175 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8176
8177 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8178
8179 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8180 socket).
8181
8182 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8183 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8184
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008185 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8186
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008187 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8188 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8189 failed.
8190
8191 Example :
8192 external-check command /bin/true
8193
8194 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8195
8196
8197external-check path <path>
8198 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8200 yes | no | yes | yes
8201
8202 Arguments :
8203 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8204
8205 The default path is "".
8206
8207 Example :
8208 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8209
8210 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8211 "external-check command"
8212
8213
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008214persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008215persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008216 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | no | yes | yes
8219 Arguments :
8220 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008221 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8222 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008223
8224 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8225 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008226 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008227 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8228 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8229 forwarded to this server.
8230
8231 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8232 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8233 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008234 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008235 a single "listen" section.
8236
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008237 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8238 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8239 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8240
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008241 Example :
8242 listen tse-farm
8243 bind :3389
8244 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8245 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8246 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8247 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8248 persist rdp-cookie
8249 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008250 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008251 balance rdp-cookie
8252 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8253 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8254
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008255 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8256 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008257
8258
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008259rate-limit sessions <rate>
8260 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8262 yes | yes | yes | no
8263 Arguments :
8264 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8265 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8266
8267 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8268 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8269 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8270 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8271 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8272 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8273
8274 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8275 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8276 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8277 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8278
8279 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8280 listen smtp
8281 mode tcp
8282 bind :25
8283 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008284 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008285
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008286 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8287 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8288 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008289
8290 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8291
8292
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008293redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8294redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8295redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008296 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8298 no | yes | yes | yes
8299
8300 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008301 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008302
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008303 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008304 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008305 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8306 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8307 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008308
8309 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8310 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8311 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8312 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8313 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008314 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8315 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8316 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8317 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008318
8319 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8320 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8321 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8322 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8323 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8324 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008325 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008326 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008327 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8328 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8329 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008330
8331 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008332 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8333 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8334 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008335 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008336 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8337 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8338 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8339 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008340
8341 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008342 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008343
8344 - "drop-query"
8345 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8346 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8347 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8348 with a location-type redirect.
8349
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008350 - "append-slash"
8351 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8352 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8353 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8354 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8355
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008356 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8357 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8358 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8359 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8360 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8361 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8362 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8363
8364 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8365 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8366 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8367 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8368 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8369 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8370 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008371
8372 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8373 acl clear dst_port 80
8374 acl secure dst_port 8080
8375 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008376 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008377 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008378 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8379
8380 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008381 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8382 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8383 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008384 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008385
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008386 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8387 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8388 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8389
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008390 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008391 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008392
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008393 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008394 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8395 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8396 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008398 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008399
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008400
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008401retries <value>
8402 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8404 yes | no | yes | yes
8405 Arguments :
8406 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8407 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8408 default value is 3.
8409
8410 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8411 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8412 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8413
8414 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008415 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8416 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008417
8418 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8419 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8420
8421 See also : "option redispatch"
8422
8423
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008424retry-on [list of keywords]
8425 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8427 yes | no | yes | yes
8428 Arguments :
8429 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8430 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8431 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8432 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8433
8434 none never retry
8435
8436 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8437 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8438
8439 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8440 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8441 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8442 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8443 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8444 processing the request.
8445
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008446 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8447 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8448 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8449 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8450 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8451 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8452 overflow attack for example).
8453
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008454 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8455 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8456 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8457 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8458 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8459 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8460 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8461 amplify denial of service attacks.
8462
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008463 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8464 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8465 considered to be safe to retry.
8466
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008467 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8468 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8469 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8470 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8471
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008472 all-retryable-errors
8473 retry request for any error that are considered
8474 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8475 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8476 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8477
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008478 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8479 not cumulative.
8480
8481 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8482 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8483 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8484 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8485
8486 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8487 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8488 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8489 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8490 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8491 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8492 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8493 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8494 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8495 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8496 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8497 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8498
8499 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8500 should not use this directive.
8501
8502 The default is "conn-failure".
8503
8504 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8505
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008506server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008507 Declare a server in a backend
8508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8509 no | no | yes | yes
8510 Arguments :
8511 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008512 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008513 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008514
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008515 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8516 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8517 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8518 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008519 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8520 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8521 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8522 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8523 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008524 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8525 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8526 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8527 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8528 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8529 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8530 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008531 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008532 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8533 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8534 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8535 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8536 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8537 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008538 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8539 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008540 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8541 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008542
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008543 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008544 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8545 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8546 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8547 adding this value to the client's port.
8548
8549 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8550 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008551 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008552
8553 Examples :
8554 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8555 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008556 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008557 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8558 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8559 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008560
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008561 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8562 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8563 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8564 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8565 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8566
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008567 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8568 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008569
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008570server-state-file-name [<file>]
8571 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8572 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8573 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8574 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8575 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8576 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8577
8578 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8579 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8580
8581 global
8582 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8583
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008584 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008585 load-server-state-from-file
8586
8587 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8588 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008589
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008590server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8591 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8592 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8594 no | no | yes | yes
8595
8596 Arguments:
8597 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8598
8599 <num | range>
8600 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8601 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8602 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8603 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8604
8605 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8606
8607 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8608
8609 <params*>
8610 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8611 keyword.
8612
8613 Examples:
8614 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8615 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8616 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8617
8618 # or
8619 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8620
8621 # would be equivalent to:
8622 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8623 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8624 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8625
8626
8627
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008629source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008630source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008631 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8633 yes | no | yes | yes
8634 Arguments :
8635 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8636 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008637
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008638 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008639 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8640 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8641 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8642 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8643 supported prefixes are :
8644 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8645 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8646 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008647 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008648 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8649 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008650
8651 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8652 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008653 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8654 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8655 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008656
8657 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8658 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8659 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8660 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8661 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8662 <addr>.
8663
8664 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8665 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8666 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8667 port.
8668
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008669 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8670 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8671 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8672 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008673 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008674 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8675 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8676 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8677 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8678 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8679 HTTP header.
8680
8681 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8682 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008683 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008684 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8685 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8686 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8687 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8688 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8689 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8690 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8691
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008692 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8693 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8694 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8695 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8696 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8697 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008699 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8700 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8701 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8702 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8703
8704 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8705 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8706 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8707 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8708 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8709 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8710
8711 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8712 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8713 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8714 there are two methods :
8715
8716 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8717 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8718 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8719 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8720 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8721 of the client ranges may be used.
8722
8723 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8724 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8725 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8726 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8727 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8728 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8729 same session.
8730
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008731 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8732 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8733 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008734 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008735
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008736 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738 Examples :
8739 backend private
8740 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8741 source 192.168.1.200
8742
8743 backend transparent_ssl1
8744 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8745 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8746
8747 backend transparent_ssl2
8748 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8749 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8750 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8751
8752 backend transparent_ssl3
8753 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8754 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8755 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8756
8757 backend transparent_smtp
8758 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8759 # with Tproxy version 4.
8760 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8761
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008762 backend transparent_http
8763 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8764 # proxy.
8765 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008767 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008768 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8769
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008770
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008771stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8772 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008774 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008775
8776 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8777 matched.
8778
8779 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8780 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8781
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008782 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8783 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008784 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008785
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008786 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8787 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8788 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8789 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008790
8791 Example :
8792 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8793 backend stats_localhost
8794 stats enable
8795 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8796
8797 Example :
8798 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8799 backend stats_auth
8800 stats enable
8801 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8802 stats admin if TRUE
8803
8804 Example :
8805 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8806 userlist stats-auth
8807 group admin users admin
8808 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8809 group readonly users haproxy
8810 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8811
8812 backend stats_auth
8813 stats enable
8814 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8815 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8816 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8817 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8818
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008819 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8820 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8821 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008822
8823
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008824stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8825 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008827 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008828 Arguments :
8829 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8830
8831 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8832
8833 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8834 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8835 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8836 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8837 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8838 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8839
8840 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8841 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8842 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008843 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008844
8845 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8846 report using "stats scope".
8847
8848 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8849 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8850 unobvious parameters.
8851
8852 Example :
8853 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8854 backend public_www
8855 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8856 stats enable
8857 stats hide-version
8858 stats scope .
8859 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008860 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008861 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8862 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8863
8864 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8865 backend private_monitoring
8866 stats enable
8867 stats uri /admin?stats
8868 stats refresh 5s
8869
8870 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8871
8872
8873stats enable
8874 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008876 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008877 Arguments : none
8878
8879 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8880 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8881 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8882 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8883 - stats auth : no authentication
8884 - stats scope : no restriction
8885
8886 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8887 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8888 unobvious parameters.
8889
8890 Example :
8891 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8892 backend public_www
8893 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8894 stats enable
8895 stats hide-version
8896 stats scope .
8897 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008898 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008899 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8900 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8901
8902 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8903 backend private_monitoring
8904 stats enable
8905 stats uri /admin?stats
8906 stats refresh 5s
8907
8908 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8909
8910
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008911stats hide-version
8912 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008914 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008915 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008916
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008917 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8918 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8919 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8920 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8921 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8922 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008924 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8925 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8926 unobvious parameters.
8927
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008928 Example :
8929 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8930 backend public_www
8931 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008932 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008933 stats hide-version
8934 stats scope .
8935 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008936 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008937 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8938 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008939
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008940 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8941 backend private_monitoring
8942 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008943 stats uri /admin?stats
8944 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008946 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008947
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008948
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008949stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8951 Access control for statistics
8952
8953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 no | no | yes | yes
8955
8956 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8957 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8958 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8959 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8960 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8961 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8962
8963 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8964 instance.
8965
8966 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8967 about ACL usage.
8968
8969
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008970stats realm <realm>
8971 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008973 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008974 Arguments :
8975 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8976 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8977 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8978
8979 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8980 using a backslash ('\').
8981
8982 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8983 only related to authentication.
8984
8985 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8986 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8987 unobvious parameters.
8988
8989 Example :
8990 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8991 backend public_www
8992 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8993 stats enable
8994 stats hide-version
8995 stats scope .
8996 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008997 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008998 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8999 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9000
9001 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9002 backend private_monitoring
9003 stats enable
9004 stats uri /admin?stats
9005 stats refresh 5s
9006
9007 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9008
9009
9010stats refresh <delay>
9011 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009013 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009014 Arguments :
9015 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9016 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9017 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9018 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9019 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9020 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9021
9022 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9023 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9024 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9025 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9026
9027 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9028 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9029 unobvious parameters.
9030
9031 Example :
9032 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9033 backend public_www
9034 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9035 stats enable
9036 stats hide-version
9037 stats scope .
9038 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009039 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009040 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9041 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9042
9043 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9044 backend private_monitoring
9045 stats enable
9046 stats uri /admin?stats
9047 stats refresh 5s
9048
9049 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9050
9051
9052stats scope { <name> | "." }
9053 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009055 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009056 Arguments :
9057 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9058 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9059 section in which the statement appears.
9060
9061 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9062 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9063 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9064 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9065 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9066 exists.
9067
9068 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9069 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9070 unobvious parameters.
9071
9072 Example :
9073 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9074 backend public_www
9075 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9076 stats enable
9077 stats hide-version
9078 stats scope .
9079 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009081 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9082 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9083
9084 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9085 backend private_monitoring
9086 stats enable
9087 stats uri /admin?stats
9088 stats refresh 5s
9089
9090 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9091
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009092
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009093stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009094 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009096 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009097
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009098 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009099 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9100
9101 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9102 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9103
9104 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9105 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009106 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009107
9108 Example :
9109 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9110 backend private_monitoring
9111 stats enable
9112 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9113 stats uri /admin?stats
9114 stats refresh 5s
9115
9116 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9117 global section.
9118
9119
9120stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009121 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9123 yes | yes | yes | yes
9124 Arguments : none
9125
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009126 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009127 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9128 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9129 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9130 - IP (socket, server)
9131 - cookie (backend, server)
9132
9133 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9134 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009135 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009136
9137 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9138
9139
9140stats show-node [ <name> ]
9141 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009144 Arguments:
9145 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9146 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9147
9148 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9149 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009150 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009151
9152 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9153 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9154 unobvious parameters.
9155
9156 Example:
9157 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9158 backend private_monitoring
9159 stats enable
9160 stats show-node Europe-1
9161 stats uri /admin?stats
9162 stats refresh 5s
9163
9164 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9165 section.
9166
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009167
9168stats uri <prefix>
9169 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009171 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009172 Arguments :
9173 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9174 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9175 query string.
9176
9177 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9178 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9179 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9180 possible to reach it in the application.
9181
9182 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009183 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009184 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9185 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9186 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9187 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9188
9189 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9190 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9191 an address or a port to statistics only.
9192
9193 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9194 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9195 unobvious parameters.
9196
9197 Example :
9198 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9199 backend public_www
9200 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9201 stats enable
9202 stats hide-version
9203 stats scope .
9204 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009205 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9207 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9208
9209 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9210 backend private_monitoring
9211 stats enable
9212 stats uri /admin?stats
9213 stats refresh 5s
9214
9215 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9216
9217
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009218stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9219 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009221 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009222
9223 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009224 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009225 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009226 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009227 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9228
9229 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9230 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9231 the "stick-table" statement.
9232
9233 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9234 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9235 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9236 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9237 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9238
9239 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9240 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9241 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9242 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9243 transformation rules.
9244
9245 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9246 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9247 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9248 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9249 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9250 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9251 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9252
9253 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9254 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9255 ACL based conditions.
9256
9257 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9258 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9259 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9260 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9261
9262 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9263 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9264 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9265 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9266
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009267 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9268 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009269 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009270
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009271 Example :
9272 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9273 # last 30 minutes
9274 backend pop
9275 mode tcp
9276 balance roundrobin
9277 stick store-request src
9278 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9279 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9280 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9281
9282 backend smtp
9283 mode tcp
9284 balance roundrobin
9285 stick match src table pop
9286 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9287 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9288
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009289 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009290 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009291
9292
9293stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9294 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9296 no | no | yes | yes
9297
9298 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9299 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9300 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9301 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9302
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009303 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9304 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009305 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009306
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009307 Examples :
9308 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009309 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009310
9311 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9312 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9313 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9314
9315
9316 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9317 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9318 backend http
9319 mode http
9320 balance roundrobin
9321 stick on src table https
9322 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9323 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9324 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9325
9326 backend https
9327 mode tcp
9328 balance roundrobin
9329 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9330 stick on src
9331 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9332 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9333
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009334 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009335
9336
9337stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9338 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9340 no | no | yes | yes
9341
9342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009343 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009344 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009345 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009346 server is selected.
9347
9348 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9349 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9350 the "stick-table" statement.
9351
9352 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9353 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9354 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9355 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9356 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9357 address.
9358
9359 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9360 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9361 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9362 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9363 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9364 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9365 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9366 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9367 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9368 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9369
9370 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9371 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9372 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9373 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9374 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9375 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9376 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9377
9378 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9379 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9380 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9381 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9382
9383 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9384 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9385 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9386 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9387 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9388 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009389 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9390 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9391 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9392 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9393 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9394 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009395
9396 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9397 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9398 the request.
9399
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009400 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9401 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009402 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009403
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009404 Example :
9405 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9406 # last 30 minutes
9407 backend pop
9408 mode tcp
9409 balance roundrobin
9410 stick store-request src
9411 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9412 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9413 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9414
9415 backend smtp
9416 mode tcp
9417 balance roundrobin
9418 stick match src table pop
9419 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9420 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9421
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009422 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009423 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009424
9425
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009426stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009427 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9428 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009429 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009431 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009432
9433 Arguments :
9434 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9435 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9436 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9437 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9438
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009439 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9440 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9441 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9442 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9443
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009444 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9445 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9446 instance.
9447
9448 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9449 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9450 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9451 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9452 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9453 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009454 to 32 characters.
9455
9456 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9457 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9458 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009459 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009460 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9461 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009462
9463 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009464 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9465 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009466 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9467 increase.
9468
9469 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009470 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9471 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9472 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009473
9474 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9475 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9476 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9477 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009478 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009479 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9480 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9481 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9482 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9483 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9484 parameter (see below).
9485
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009486 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9487 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9488 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9489 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9490 soft restart.
9491
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009492 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9493 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009494
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009495 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9496 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9497 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9498 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009499 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009500 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009501 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9502 if not expiration delay is specified.
9503
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009504 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9505 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9506 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9507 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009508 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9509 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9510 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9511 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9512 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9513 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9514 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9515 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9516 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9517 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9518 types and their arguments.
9519
9520 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9521 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9522 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9523 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9524
9525 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9526 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9527 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009528 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009529
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009530 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9531 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9532 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009533 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009534 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009535 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009536
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009537 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9538 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9539 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9540 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9541
9542 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9543 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9544 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9545 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9546 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9547 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9548
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009549 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9550 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9551 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9552 they were received.
9553
9554 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9555 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9556 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9557 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9558 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9559
9560 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9561 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9562 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9563 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9564 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9565
9566 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9567 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9568 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9569
9570 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9571 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9572 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9573 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9574 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9575
9576 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9577 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9578 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9579 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9580 the client side.
9581
9582 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9583 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9584 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9585 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9586 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9587 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9588 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9589
9590 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9591 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9592 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9593 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9594 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9595 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009596 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009597
9598 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9599 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9600 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9601 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9602 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9603 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9604
9605 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009607 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9608 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9609
9610 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9611 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9612 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9613 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9614 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9615 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9616 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9617 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9618 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9619 recommended for better fairness.
9620
9621 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009622 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009623 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9624 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9625
9626 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9627 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9628 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9629 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9630 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9631 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9632 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9633 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9634 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9635 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009636
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009637 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9638 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009639 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9640 reference it.
9641
9642 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9643 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009644 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9645 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9646 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009647
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009648 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9649 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9650 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9651 something that can be ignored.
9652
9653 Example:
9654 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9655 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9656 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9657 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9658
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009659 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009660 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009661
9662
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009663stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009664 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9666 no | no | yes | yes
9667
9668 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009669 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009670 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009671 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009672 server is selected.
9673
9674 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9675 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9676 the "stick-table" statement.
9677
9678 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9679 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9680 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9681 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9682
9683 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9684 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9685 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9686 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9687 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9688 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009689 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009690 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9691 rules.
9692
9693 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9694 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9695 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9696 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9697 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9698 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9699 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9700
9701 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9702 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9703 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9704 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9705
9706 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9707 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9708 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9709 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9710 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9711 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009712 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9713 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9714 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9715 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9716 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9717 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9718 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9719 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9720 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009721
9722 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9723
9724 Example :
9725 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9726 backend https
9727 mode tcp
9728 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009729 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009730 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009731
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009732 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9733 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9734
9735 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9736 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9737 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9738
9739 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9740 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009741
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009742 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9743 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9744 # at offset 44.
9745
9746 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9747 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9748
9749 # Learn on response if server hello.
9750 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009751
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009752 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9753 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9754
9755 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9756 extraction.
9757
9758
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009759tcp-check connect [params*]
9760 Opens a new connection
9761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9762 no | no | yes | yes
9763
9764 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9765 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9766 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9767
9768 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9769 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9770 of the sequence.
9771
9772 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9773 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9774 do.
9775
9776 Parameters :
9777 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9778 use the TCP connection.
9779
9780 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9781 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9782 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9783
9784 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9785
9786 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9787
9788 Examples:
9789 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9790 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9791 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9792 option tcp-check
9793 tcp-check connect
9794 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9795 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9796 tcp-check send \r\n
9797 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9798 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9799 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9800 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9801 tcp-check send \r\n
9802 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9803 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9804
9805 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9806 option tcp-check
9807 tcp-check connect port 110
9808 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9809 tcp-check connect port 143
9810 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9811 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9812
9813 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9814
9815
9816tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009817 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9819 no | no | yes | yes
9820
9821 Arguments :
9822 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9823 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9824 binary.
9825 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9826 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9827 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9828
9829 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9830 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9831 with the usual backslash ('\').
9832 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009833 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009834 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9835 used upper or lower case.
9836
9837
9838 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9839
9840 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9841 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9842 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9843 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9844 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9845 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9846 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9847 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9848
9849 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9851 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9852 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9853 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9854 expression.
9855
9856 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9857 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9858 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9859 this exact hexadecimal string.
9860 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9861
9862 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9863 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9864 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9865 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9866 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9867 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9868 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9869 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9870 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9871 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9872 the null character.
9873
9874 Examples :
9875 # perform a POP check
9876 option tcp-check
9877 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9878
9879 # perform an IMAP check
9880 option tcp-check
9881 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9882
9883 # look for the redis master server
9884 option tcp-check
9885 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009886 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009887 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9888 tcp-check expect string role:master
9889 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9890 tcp-check expect string +OK
9891
9892
9893 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9894 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9895
9896
9897tcp-check send <data>
9898 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9900 no | no | yes | yes
9901
9902 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9903 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9904
9905 Examples :
9906 # look for the redis master server
9907 option tcp-check
9908 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9909 tcp-check expect string role:master
9910
9911 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9912 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9913
9914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009915tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9916 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009917 tcp health check
9918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9919 no | no | yes | yes
9920
9921 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9922 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009923 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009924 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9925 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9926 hexadecimal string.
9927 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9928
9929 Examples :
9930 # redis check in binary
9931 option tcp-check
9932 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9933 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9934
9935
9936 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9937 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9938
9939
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009940tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9941 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9943 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009944 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009945 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9946 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009948 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009949
9950 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9951 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009952 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9953 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9954 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9955 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9956 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9957 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009958
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009959 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9960 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9961 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9962 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009963
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009964 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009965 - accept :
9966 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9967 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9968 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009969
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009970 - reject :
9971 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9972 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9973 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9974 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9975 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9976 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9977 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9978 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9979 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9980 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9981 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009982 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009983
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009984 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9985 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9986 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9987 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9988 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9989 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9990 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9991 hosts.
9992
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009993 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9994 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9995 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9996 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9997 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9998 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9999 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10000 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10001
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010002 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10003 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10004 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10005 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10006 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10007 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10008 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10009 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10010 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010011 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10012 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010013
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010014 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010015 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010016 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10017 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10018 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010019 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010020 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10021 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10022 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10023 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10024 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10025 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10026 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10027 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010029 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010030 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010031 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010032 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010033 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10034 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10035 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010037 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10038 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10039 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10040 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010042 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10043 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10044 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10045 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10046 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010047 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10048 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10049 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10050 layer7 information is extracted.
10051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010052 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10053 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10054 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10055 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10056 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010057
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010058 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10059 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10060 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10061 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10062
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010063 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10064 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10065 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10066 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10067
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010068 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10069 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10070 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10071 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10072 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010073
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010074 - set-src <expr> :
10075 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10076 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10077 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010078 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010080 Arguments:
10081 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10082 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010083
10084 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010085 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10086
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010087 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10088 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010089
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010090 - set-src-port <expr> :
10091 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10092 expression.
10093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010094 Arguments:
10095 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10096 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010097
10098 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010099 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10100
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010101 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10102 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10103 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010104
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010105 - set-dst <expr> :
10106 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10107 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10108 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10109 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10110 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10111
10112 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10113 followed by some converters.
10114
10115 Example:
10116
10117 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10118 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10119
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010120 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10121 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10122
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010123 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10124 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10125 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10126 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10127
10128
10129 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10130 followed by some converters.
10131
10132 Example:
10133
10134 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10135
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010136 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10137 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10138 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10139
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010140 - "silent-drop" :
10141 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010142 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010143 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10144 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10145 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10146 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10147 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010148 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10149 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010150 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10151 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010152 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010153 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10154 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10155 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10156 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010158 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10159 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10160 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010162 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10163 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10164 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010166 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010167 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010168 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010170 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10171 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10172 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010175 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10176 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010177
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010178 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10179
10180 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10181
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010182 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10183
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010184 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010185
10186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010187tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10188 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010190 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010191 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010192 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10193 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010195 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010196
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010197 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010198 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10199 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10200 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10201 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010203 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10204 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10205 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10206 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010207 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10208 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10209 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10210 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10211 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10212 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010213 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010214 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010216 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10217 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10218 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10219 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010220
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010221 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010222 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010223 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010224 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10225 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010226 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010227 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010228 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010229 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010230 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010231 - set-dst <expr>
10232 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010233 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010234 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010235 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010236 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010237 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010239 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10240 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010241 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10242 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010243
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010244 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10245 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10246 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10247 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10248 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10249 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010251 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010252 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10253 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010254
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010255 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010256 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10257 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10258 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10259 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010260 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10261 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10262 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010263
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010264 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010265 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10266 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10267 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010268
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010269 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10270 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10271
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010272 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010273 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10274 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010275
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010276 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10277 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010278 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010279 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10280 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010281 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010282 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010283 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010284 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10285 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010287 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10288 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010289
10290 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10291 followed by some converters.
10292
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010293 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10294 <var-name>.
10295
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010296 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10297 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10298 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10299 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10300 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10301
10302 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10303 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10304 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10305 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10306 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10307 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10308 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10309 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10310 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10311 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10312 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10313
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010314 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10315 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10316 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10317 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10318 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10319
10320 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10321
10322 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10323
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010324 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10325 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10326 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10327 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10328 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10329 evaluated.
10330
10331 Example:
10332 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10333
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010334 Example:
10335
10336 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010337 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010338
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010339 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010340 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10341 # and reject everything else.
10342 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10343 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010344 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010345 tcp-request content reject
10346
10347 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010348 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10349 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10350 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010351 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010352
10353 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10354 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10355 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010356 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010357 tcp-request content reject
10358
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010359 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010360 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010361 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010362 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010363 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10364 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010365
10366 Example:
10367 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10368 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010369 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010371 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010372 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010373
10374 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010375 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010376 # protecting all our sites
10377 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010378 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10379 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380 ...
10381 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10382
10383 backend http_dynamic
10384 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010385 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010386 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010387 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010388 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010389 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010390 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010392 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010393
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010394 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10395 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010396
10397
10398tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10399 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010401 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010402 Arguments :
10403 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10405 as explained at the top of this document.
10406
10407 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10408 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10409 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10410 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10411 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10412
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010413 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10414 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10415 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10416 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10417
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010418 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10419 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010420 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010421 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010422 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10423 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10424 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10425 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010426
10427 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10428 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10429 it pass through unaffected.
10430
10431 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10432 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10433 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010434 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010435 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10436 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010437 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10438 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10439 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010441 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010442 "timeout client".
10443
10444
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010445tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10446 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10448 no | no | yes | yes
10449 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010450 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10451 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010452
10453 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10454
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010455 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010456 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10457 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010458 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10459 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010460
10461 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10462
10463 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10464 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10465 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10466 inserted.
10467
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010468 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010469 - accept :
10470 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10471 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10472 the rules evaluation.
10473
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010474 - close :
10475 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10476 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10477 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10478 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10479 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10480 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010481 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010482 protocols.
10483
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010484 - reject :
10485 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10486 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010487 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010488
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010489 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10490 Sets a variable.
10491
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010492 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10493 Unsets a variable.
10494
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010495 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10496 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10497 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10498 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10499
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010500 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10501 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10502 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10503 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10504
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010505 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10506 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10507 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10508 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10509 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010510
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010511 - "silent-drop" :
10512 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010514 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10515 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10516 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10517 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10518 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010519 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10520 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010521 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10522 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010523 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010524 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10525 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10526 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10527 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10528
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010529 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10530 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10531
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010532 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10533 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10534 for changing the default action to a reject.
10535
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010536 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10537 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10538 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10539 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010540 period.
10541
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010542 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10543 declared inline.
10544
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010545 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10546 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010550 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010551 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010552 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010553 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10554 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010555 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010556 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10557 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010558
10559 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10560 followed by some converters.
10561
10562 Example:
10563
10564 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10565
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010566 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10567 <var-name>.
10568
10569 Example:
10570
10571 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10572
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010573 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10574 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10575 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10576 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10577 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10578
10579 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10580
10581 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10582
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010583 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10584
10585 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10586
10587
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010588tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10589 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10591 no | yes | yes | no
10592 Arguments :
10593 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10594 below.
10595
10596 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010598 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010599 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10600 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10601 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10602 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10603 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10604 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10605 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010606 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010607 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10608 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10609 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10610 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10611 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10612 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10613 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10614 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10615 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10616 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10617 instead.
10618
10619 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10620 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10621 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10622 rules which may be inserted.
10623
10624 Several types of actions are supported :
10625 - accept : the request is accepted
10626 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10627 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10628 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010629 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010630 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010631 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010632 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010633 - silent-drop
10634
10635 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10636 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10637 sections for a complete description.
10638
10639 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10640 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10641 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10642
10643 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10644 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10645 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10646 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10647 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10648
10649 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10650 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10651
10652 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10653 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10654 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10655
10656 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10657 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10658 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10659
10660 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10661 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10662 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10663
10664 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10665 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10666 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10667
10668 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10669
10670 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10671
10672
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010673tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10674 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10676 no | no | yes | yes
10677 Arguments :
10678 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10679 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10680 as explained at the top of this document.
10681
10682 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10683
10684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010685timeout check <timeout>
10686 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10687 established.
10688
10689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10690 yes | no | yes | yes
10691 Arguments:
10692 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10693 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10694 as explained at the top of this document.
10695
10696 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10697 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010698 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010699 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010700 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10701 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10702 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010703
10704 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10705 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10706
10707 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10708 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010709 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010710
10711 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10712 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10713 forget about it.
10714
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010715 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10716 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010717
10718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010719timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010720 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10722 yes | yes | yes | no
10723 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10726 as explained at the top of this document.
10727
10728 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10729 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10730 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010731 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10732 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10733 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10734 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010735 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10736 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10737 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010738 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010739 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10741 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010742 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10743 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744
10745 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10746 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10747 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10748 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010749 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010750 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10751
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010752 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010753
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010754 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010756
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010757timeout client-fin <timeout>
10758 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10760 yes | yes | yes | no
10761 Arguments :
10762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10764 as explained at the top of this document.
10765
10766 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10767 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10768 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10769 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10770 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10771 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10772 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010773 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10774 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10775 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010776
10777 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10778 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10779 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10780
10781 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10782
10783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010784timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010785 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10787 yes | no | yes | yes
10788 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010789 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010790 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10791 as explained at the top of this document.
10792
10793 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010794 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010795 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010796 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010797 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10798 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010799
10800 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10801 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10802 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10803 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010804 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010805 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10806
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010807 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010809
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010810timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10811 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10813 yes | yes | yes | yes
10814 Arguments :
10815 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10816 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10817 as explained at the top of this document.
10818
10819 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10820 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10821 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10822 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10823 once the request has started to present itself.
10824
10825 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10826 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10827 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10828 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10829 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10830
10831 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10832 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10833 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10834 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10835
10836 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10837 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010838 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010839 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10840 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010841 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010842
10843 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10844 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10845 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10846 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10847
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010848 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10849 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010850 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10851
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010852 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10853
10854
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010855timeout http-request <timeout>
10856 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010858 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010859 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10862 as explained at the top of this document.
10863
10864 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10865 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10866 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10867 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10868 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10869 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10870 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010871 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10872 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10873 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10874 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010875 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010876 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10877 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010878
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010879 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10880 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10881 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10882 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10883 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010884 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010885
10886 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10887 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010888 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010889 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10890 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10891
10892 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010893 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10894 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10895 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010896
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010897 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010898 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010899
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010900
10901timeout queue <timeout>
10902 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10904 yes | no | yes | yes
10905 Arguments :
10906 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10908 as explained at the top of this document.
10909
10910 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10911 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10912 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10913 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10914 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10915
10916 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10917 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10918 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10919 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10920
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010921 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010922
10923
10924timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010925 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10927 yes | no | yes | yes
10928 Arguments :
10929 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10930 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10931 as explained at the top of this document.
10932
10933 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10934 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10935 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10936 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10937 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10938 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10939 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10940
10941 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10942 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10943 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10944 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10945 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010946 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010947 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10949 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010950 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10951 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010952
10953 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10954 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10955 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10956 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010957 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010958 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10959
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010960 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010961
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010962
10963timeout server-fin <timeout>
10964 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10966 yes | no | yes | yes
10967 Arguments :
10968 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10969 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10970 as explained at the top of this document.
10971
10972 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10973 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10974 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10975 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10976 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10977 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10978 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10979 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10980 situations, it should not be needed.
10981
10982 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10983 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10984 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10985
10986 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10987
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010988
10989timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010990 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10992 yes | yes | yes | yes
10993 Arguments :
10994 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10995 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10996 as explained at the top of this document.
10997
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010998 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10999 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11000 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011001
11002 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11003 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11004 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11005 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011006 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011007
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011008 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011009
11010
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011011timeout tunnel <timeout>
11012 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11014 yes | no | yes | yes
11015 Arguments :
11016 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11017 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11018 as explained at the top of this document.
11019
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011020 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011021 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11022 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11023 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011024 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11025 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011026 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11027 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11028 specified.
11029
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011030 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11031 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11032 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11033 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11034 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11035 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11036 state.
11037
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011038 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11039 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11040 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11041 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011043
11044 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11045 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11046 forget about it.
11047
11048 Example :
11049 defaults http
11050 option http-server-close
11051 timeout connect 5s
11052 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011053 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011054 timeout server 30s
11055 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11056
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011057 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011058
11059
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011060transparent (deprecated)
11061 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011063 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011064 Arguments : none
11065
11066 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11067 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11068 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11069 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11070 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11071 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11072 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11073 appropriate server.
11074
11075 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11076
11077 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11078 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11079
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011080 See also: "option transparent"
11081
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011082unique-id-format <string>
11083 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11085 yes | yes | yes | no
11086 Arguments :
11087 <string> is a log-format string.
11088
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011089 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11090 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11091 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11092 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011093
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011094 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11095 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11096 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11097 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11098 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11099 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11100 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11101 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011102
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011103 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11104 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011105
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011106 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011107
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011108 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011109
11110 will generate:
11111
11112 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11113
11114 See also: "unique-id-header"
11115
11116unique-id-header <name>
11117 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11119 yes | yes | yes | no
11120 Arguments :
11121 <name> is the name of the header.
11122
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011123 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11124 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011125
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011126 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011127
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011128 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011129 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11130
11131 will generate:
11132
11133 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11134
11135 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011136
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011137use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011138 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11140 no | yes | yes | no
11141 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011142 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11143 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011144
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011145 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11146 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011147
11148 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11149 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11150 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011151 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011152 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011153 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11154 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011155
11156 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11157 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11158 assign the backend.
11159
11160 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11161 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11162 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11163 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11164 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11165 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11166
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011167 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011168 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011169 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11170 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11171 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11172
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011173 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11174 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11175 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11176 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11177 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11178 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11179 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11180 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11181 cannot be forced from the request.
11182
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011183 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011184 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11185 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11186
11187 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11188 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011189
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011190use-fcgi-app <name>
11191 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11193 no | no | yes | yes
11194 Arguments :
11195 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11196
11197 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011198
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011199use-server <server> if <condition>
11200use-server <server> unless <condition>
11201 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11203 no | no | yes | yes
11204 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011205 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11206 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011207
11208 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11209
11210 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11211 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11212 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11213
11214 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11215 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11216 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11217 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11218 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11219 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11220 matches will assign the server.
11221
11222 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11223 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11224 with the next rules until one matches.
11225
11226 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11227 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11228 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11229 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11230
11231 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11232 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11233 stripped.
11234
11235 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11236 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11237 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11238 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11239
11240 Example :
11241 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11242 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11243 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11244 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11245 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11246 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011247 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011248 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11249 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11250
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011251 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11252 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11253 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11254 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11255 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11256 and we fall back to load balancing.
11257
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011258 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011260
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011262--------------------------
11263
11264The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11265depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11266settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11267written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11268described in this section.
11269
11270
112715.1. Bind options
11272-----------------
11273
11274The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11275as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11276no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11277parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11278while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11279provided immediately after the setting name.
11280
11281The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11282
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011283accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11284 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11285 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11286 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11287 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11288 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11289 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11290 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11291 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11292 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011293 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11294 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11295 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011297accept-proxy
11298 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011299 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11300 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011301 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11302 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11303 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11304 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011305 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11307 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011308 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11309 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011310
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011311allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011312 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011313 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011314 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011315 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11316 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011317
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011318alpn <protocols>
11319 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11320 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11321 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011322 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011323 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011324 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11325 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11326 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11327 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11328 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11329 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11330 preference, like below :
11331
11332 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011333
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011334backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011335 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011336 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11337
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011338curves <curves>
11339 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11340 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11341 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11342 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11343 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11344 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11345
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011346ecdhe <named curve>
11347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011348 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11349 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011350
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011351ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11353 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11354 client's certificate.
11355
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011356ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11358 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11359 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11360 error is ignored.
11361
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011362ca-sign-file <cafile>
11363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11364 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11365 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11366 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11367 'generate-certificates' for details.
11368
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011369ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11371 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11372 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11373 'generate-certificates' for details.
11374
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011375ca-verify-file <cafile>
11376 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11377 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11378 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11379 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11380 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011382ciphers <ciphers>
11383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11384 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011385 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011386 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011387 information and recommendations see e.g.
11388 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11389 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11390 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11391
11392ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11394 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11395 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11396 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011397 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11398 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011399
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011400crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11402 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11403 to verify client's certificate.
11404
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011405crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11407 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11408 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11409 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11410 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011411 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11412 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011413
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011414 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11415 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11416
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011417 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11418 are loaded.
11419
11420 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011421 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11422 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11423 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11424 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11425 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11426 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11427 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011428 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011429
11430 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11431 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11432 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11433 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011434 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11435 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011436
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011437 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011438
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011439 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011440 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011441 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11442 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011443 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11444 clients).
11445
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011446 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11447 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11448 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11449 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11450 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11451 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11452 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11453 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11454 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11455 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11456 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11457 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11458 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11459
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011460 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11461 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11462 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11463 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11464 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11465
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011466 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11467 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11468 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11469 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011470
11471 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11472 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11473 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11474 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11475 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11476 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11477 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11478 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11479 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11480
11481 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11482
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011483 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011484 a cert bundle.
11485
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011486 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011487 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11488 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11489 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11490 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11491 provide multi-cert support.
11492
11493 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11494
11495 Filename | CN | SAN
11496 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11497 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011498 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011499 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11500 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11501
11502 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11503 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11504 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11505 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011506 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11507 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11508 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011509
11510 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11511 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11512
11513 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11514 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11515 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11516
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011517crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011520 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011521 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011522
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011523crt-list <file>
11524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011525 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11526 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011527
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011528 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11529
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011530 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11531 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11532 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11533 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011534
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011535 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11536 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11537 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11538 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11539 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11540 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11541 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11542 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011543
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011544 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011545 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011546 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11547 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11548 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011549
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011550 crt-list file example:
11551 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011552 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011553 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011554 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011556defer-accept
11557 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11558 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11559 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011561 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11562 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11563 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11564 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11565 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11566 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11567 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11568
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011569expose-fd listeners
11570 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11571 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011572 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11573 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011574 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011575
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011576force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011577 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011578 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011579 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011580 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011581
11582force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011583 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011584 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011585 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011586
11587force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011588 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011589 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011590 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011591
11592force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011593 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011594 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011595 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011596
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011597force-tlsv13
11598 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11599 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011600 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011601
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011602generate-certificates
11603 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11604 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11605 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11606 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11607 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11608 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11609 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11610 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11611 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11612 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11613 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11614
11615 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11616 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011617 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011618 certificate is used many times.
11619
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011620gid <gid>
11621 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11622 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11623 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11624 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11625 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11626
11627group <group>
11628 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11629 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11630 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11631 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11632 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11633
11634id <id>
11635 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11636 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11637 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11638 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11639
11640interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011641 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11642 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11643 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11644 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11645 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11646 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011647 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11648 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11649 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11650 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11651 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11652 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011653
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011654level <level>
11655 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11656 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11657 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011658 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011659 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11660 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11661 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011662 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011663 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011664 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011665 all counters).
11666
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011667severity-output <format>
11668 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11669 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11670 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11671 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11672 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11673 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11674 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11675 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11676 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11677 rfc5424 convention.
11678
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011679maxconn <maxconn>
11680 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11681 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11682 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11683 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11684 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11685 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11686 eat all memory.
11687
11688mode <mode>
11689 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11690 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11691 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11692 UNIX sockets.
11693
11694mss <maxseg>
11695 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11696 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11697 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11698 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11699 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11700 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11701 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11702 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11703 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11704 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11705 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11706
11707name <name>
11708 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11709 page.
11710
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011711namespace <name>
11712 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11713 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11714 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11715 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11716
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011717nice <nice>
11718 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11719 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11720 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11721 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11722 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11723 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11724 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11725 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11726 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11727 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11728 one for an RDP socket.
11729
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011730no-ca-names
11731 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11732 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011733 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011734
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011735no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011737 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011738 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011739 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011740 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11741 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011742
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011743no-tls-tickets
11744 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11745 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11746 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011747 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11748 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011749 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11750 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11751 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011752
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011753no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011754 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011755 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011756 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011757 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011758 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11759 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011760
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011761no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011763 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011764 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011765 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011766 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11767 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011768
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011769no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011771 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011772 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011773 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011774 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11775 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011776
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011777no-tlsv13
11778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11779 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11780 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11781 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011782 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11783 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011784
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011785npn <protocols>
11786 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11787 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11788 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011789 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011790 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011791 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11792 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11793 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11794 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11795 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011796
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011797prefer-client-ciphers
11798 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11799 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11800 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011801 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11802 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11803 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011804
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011805process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011806 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011807 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011808 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011809 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11810 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11811 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11812 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011813 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011814 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11815 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11816 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11817 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11818 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011819
11820 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11821
11822 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11823 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11824 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11825 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11826 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11827 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11828 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11829 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011830
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011831proto <name>
11832 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11833 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11834 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11835 in haproxy -vv.
11836 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11837 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011838 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011839 h2" on the bind line.
11840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011841ssl
11842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011843 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011844 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11845 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011846 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11847 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011848
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011849ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11850 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11851 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11852 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11853
11854ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11855 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11856 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11857 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11858
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011859strict-sni
11860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11861 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11862 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11863 See the "crt" option for more information.
11864
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011865tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011866 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011867 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11868 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011869 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011870 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11871 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11872 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11873 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11874 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11875 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11876 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11877
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011878tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011879 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011880 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11881 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11882 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11883 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11884 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11885 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11886 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011887 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11888 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11889 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011890
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011891tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11892 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011893 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11894 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11895 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11896 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11897 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11898 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11899 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11900 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11901 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11902 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011903 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11904 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11905
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011906transparent
11907 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11908 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11909 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11910 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11911 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11912 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11913 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11914 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11915 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11916 so check for support with your vendor.
11917
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011918v4v6
11919 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11920 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11921 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11922 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011923 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011924
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011925v6only
11926 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11927 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11928 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011929 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11930 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011931
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011932uid <uid>
11933 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11934 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11935 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11936 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11937 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11938
11939user <user>
11940 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11941 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11942 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11943 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11944 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11945
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011946verify [none|optional|required]
11947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11948 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11949 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11950 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11951 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011952 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11953 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11954 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11955 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011956
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119575.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011958------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011960The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11961which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11962arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11963settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11964after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11965Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11966address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011968 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011969 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011970
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011971Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11972keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011974The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011975
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011976addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011977 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011978 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11979 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11980 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11981 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11982 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011983
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011984agent-check
11985 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011986 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011987 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11988 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11989 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011990
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011991 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011992 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011993 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11994 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11995 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011996
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011997 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11998 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11999 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12000 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12001 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012002
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012003 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012004 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012005
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012006 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12007 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12008 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012009
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012010 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12011 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12012 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012013
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012014 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12015 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12016 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12017 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12018 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012019 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012020 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012021
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012022 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12023 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012024
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012025 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12026 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12027 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12028 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12029 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12030 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12031 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12032 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12033 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012034
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012035 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12036 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012037 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12038 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12039 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012040 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012041
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012042 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012043 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012044
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012045agent-send <string>
12046 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12047 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12048 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12049 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12050 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12051
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012052agent-inter <delay>
12053 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12054 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12055
12056 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12057 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12058 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12059 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12060 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12061 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12062 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12063 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12064 of backends use the same servers.
12065
12066 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12067
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012068agent-addr <addr>
12069 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12070
12071 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12072 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12073 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12074 hostname, it will be resolved.
12075
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012076agent-port <port>
12077 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12078
12079 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12080
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012081allow-0rtt
12082 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012083 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12084 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012085
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012086alpn <protocols>
12087 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12088 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12089 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012090 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012091 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12092 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12093 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12094 now obsolete NPN extension.
12095 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12096 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12097
12098 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012100backup
12101 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12102 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12103 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12104 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012105 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12106 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012107
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012108ca-file <cafile>
12109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12110 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12111 server's certificate.
12112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012113check
12114 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012115 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12116 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12117 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12118 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12119 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12120 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12121 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012122 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12123 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012124 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12125 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012126
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012127check-send-proxy
12128 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12129 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12130 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12131 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12132 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12133 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12134 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12135
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012136check-alpn <protocols>
12137 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12138 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12139 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12140
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012141check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012142 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012143 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12144 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012145
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012146check-ssl
12147 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12148 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12149 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12150 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012151 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012152 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12153 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012154 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012155 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12156 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012157
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012158check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012159 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012160 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12161 for normal traffic.
12162
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012163ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12165 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12166 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012167 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12168 information and recommendations see e.g.
12169 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12170 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12171 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012172
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012173ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12175 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12176 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12177 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012178 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12179 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12180 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012182cookie <value>
12183 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12184 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12185 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12186 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12187 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12188 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12189 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12190
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012191crl-file <crlfile>
12192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12193 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12194 to verify server's certificate.
12195
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012196crt <cert>
12197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12198 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12199 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12200 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12201 certificate request.
12202
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012203disabled
12204 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12205 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12206 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12207 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12208 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012209 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012210
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012211enabled
12212 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12213 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12214 default value.
12215 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12216 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012218error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012219 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12220 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12221 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012223 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012225fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012226 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12227 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12228 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12229
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012230force-sslv3
12231 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12232 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012233 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012234 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012235
12236force-tlsv10
12237 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012238 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012239 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012240
12241force-tlsv11
12242 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012243 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012244 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012245
12246force-tlsv12
12247 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012248 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012249 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012250
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012251force-tlsv13
12252 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12253 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012254 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012256id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012257 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12258 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12259 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012260
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012261init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12262 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12263 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012264 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012265 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12266 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12267 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12268 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12269 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12270 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12271 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12272 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12273 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012274 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012275 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12276 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12277 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12278 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12279 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12280 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012281 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012282
12283 Example:
12284 defaults
12285 # never fail on address resolution
12286 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012288inter <delay>
12289fastinter <delay>
12290downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012291 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12292 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12293 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12294 between checks depending on the server state :
12295
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012296 Server state | Interval used
12297 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12298 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12299 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12300 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12301 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12302 or yet unchecked. |
12303 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12304 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12305 | "inter" otherwise.
12306 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012308 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12309 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12310 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12311 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012312 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12313 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12314 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12315 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12316 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012318maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012319 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12320 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012321 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12322 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012323 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12324 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12325 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12326 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12327
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012328 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12329 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12330 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12331 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12332 than 50 concurrent requests.
12333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012334maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012335 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12336 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12337 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12338 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12339 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12340 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12341 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12342
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012343max-reuse <count>
12344 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12345 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12346 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12347 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12348 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12349 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12350 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12351 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012353minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012354 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12355 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12356 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12357 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12358 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12359 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012360 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012361 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012362
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012363namespace <name>
12364 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12365 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12366 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12367 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12368
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012369no-agent-check
12370 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12371 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12372 default value.
12373 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12374 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12375
12376no-backup
12377 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12378 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12379 default value.
12380 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12381 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12382
12383no-check
12384 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12385 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12386 default value.
12387 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12388 "default-server" "check" setting.
12389
12390no-check-ssl
12391 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12392 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12393 default value.
12394 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12395 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12396
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012397no-send-proxy
12398 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12399 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12400 default value.
12401 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12402 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12403
12404no-send-proxy-v2
12405 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12406 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12407 default value.
12408 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12409 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12410
12411no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12412 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12413 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12414 default value.
12415 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12416 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12417
12418no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12419 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12420 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12421 default value.
12422 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12423 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12424
12425no-ssl
12426 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12427 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12428 default value.
12429 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12430 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12431
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012432no-ssl-reuse
12433 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12434 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12435 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12436 and for paranoid users.
12437
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012438no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012439 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12440 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012441 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012442
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012443 Supported in default-server: No
12444
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012445no-tls-tickets
12446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12447 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12448 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012449 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12450 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012451 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12452 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12453 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012454 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012455
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012456no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012457 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012458 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12459 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012460 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12461 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012462 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012463
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012464 Supported in default-server: No
12465
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012466no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012467 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012468 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12469 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012470 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12471 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012472 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012473
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012474 Supported in default-server: No
12475
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012476no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012477 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012478 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12479 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012480 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12481 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012482 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012483
12484 Supported in default-server: No
12485
12486no-tlsv13
12487 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12488 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12489 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12490 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12491 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012492 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012493
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012494 Supported in default-server: No
12495
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012496no-verifyhost
12497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12499 default value.
12500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12501 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012502
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012503no-tfo
12504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12506 default value.
12507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12508 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12509
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012510non-stick
12511 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12512 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12513 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12514
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012515npn <protocols>
12516 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12517 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12518 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012519 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012520 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12521 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12522 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012524observe <mode>
12525 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12526 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12527 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12528 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12529 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12530 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012531 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012532
12533 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012535on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012536 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12537 Currently, four modes are available:
12538 - fastinter: force fastinter
12539 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12540 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12541 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12542 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12543
12544 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12545
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012546on-marked-down <action>
12547 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12548 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012549 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12550 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12551 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12552 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12553 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12554 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12555 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12556 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012557
12558 Actions are disabled by default
12559
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012560on-marked-up <action>
12561 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12562 Currently one action is available:
12563 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12564 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12565 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12566 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012567 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12568 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012569 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12570 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12571
12572 Actions are disabled by default
12573
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012574pool-max-conn <max>
12575 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12576 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12577 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12578 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12579 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12580 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12581
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012582pool-purge-delay <delay>
12583 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012584 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012585 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012587port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012588 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12589 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12590 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12591 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12592 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12593 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12594
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012595proto <name>
12596
12597 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12598 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12599 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12600 reported in haproxy -vv.
12601 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12602 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012604redir <prefix>
12605 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12606 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12607 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12608 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12609 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12610 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12611 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12612 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012613 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012614 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012615 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12616 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12617 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12618 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12619
12620 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012622rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012623 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12624 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12625 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12626
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012627resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12628 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12629 server.
12630
12631 Available options:
12632
12633 * allow-dup-ip
12634 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12635 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12636 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12637 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12638 For such case, simply enable this option.
12639 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12640
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012641 * ignore-weight
12642 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12643 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12644 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12645
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012646 * prevent-dup-ip
12647 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12648 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12649 same fqdn.
12650 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12651
12652 Example:
12653 backend b_myapp
12654 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12655 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12656 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12657
12658 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12659 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12660 it
12661 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12662 different address
12663
12664 Default value: not set
12665
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012666resolve-prefer <family>
12667 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12668 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12669 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12670 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12671
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012672 Default value: ipv6
12673
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012674 Example:
12675
12676 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012677
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012678resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012679 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012680 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012681 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012682 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12683 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012684 configured network, another address is selected.
12685
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012686 Example:
12687
12688 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012689
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012690resolvers <id>
12691 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12692 hostname.
12693
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012694 Example:
12695
12696 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012697
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012698 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012699
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012700send-proxy
12701 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12702 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12703 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12704 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012705 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12706 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12707 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12708 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12709 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12710 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12711 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12712 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12713 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12714 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012715 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12716 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012717
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012718send-proxy-v2
12719 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12720 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12721 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12722 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012723 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12724 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12725 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12726 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012727
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012728proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012729 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12730 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12731
12732 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12733 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12734 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12735 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12736 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12737 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12738 connection is supported).
12739 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12740 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12741 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12742 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12743 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12744 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12745 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012746
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012747send-proxy-v2-ssl
12748 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12749 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12750 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12751 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12752 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12753 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12754 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012755 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12756 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012757
12758send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12759 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12760 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12761 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12762 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12763 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12764 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12765 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12766 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012767 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12768 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012770slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012771 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12772 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12773 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12774 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12775 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12776 parameters :
12777
12778 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12779 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12780
12781 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12782 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12783 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12784 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12785
12786 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12787 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12788 seen as failed.
12789
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012790sni <expression>
12791 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12792 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12793 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12794 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012795 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12796 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012797 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012798 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12799 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012800
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012801source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012802source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012803source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012804 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12805 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12806 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12807 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12808
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012809 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12810 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12811 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12812 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12813 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12814 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12815 server.
12816
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012817 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12818 specifying the source address without port(s).
12819
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012820ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012821 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12822 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12823 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12824 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12825 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12826 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012827 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12828 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012829
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012830ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12831 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12832 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12833 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12834
12835ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12836 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12837 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12838 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12839
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012840ssl-reuse
12841 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12842 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12843 default value.
12844 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12845 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12846
12847stick
12848 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12849 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12850 default value.
12851 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12852 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012853
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012854socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012855 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012856 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12857 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12858
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012859tcp-ut <delay>
12860 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12861 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12862 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012863 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012864 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12865 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12866 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12867 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12868 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12869 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12870 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12871 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12872 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12873
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012874tfo
12875 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12876 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12877 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12878 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12879 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012880 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012882track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012883 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12884 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12885 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12886 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012887 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12888
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012889tls-tickets
12890 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12891 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12892 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012893 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12894 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12895 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012896 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012897 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012898
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012899verify [none|required]
12900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012901 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012902 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12903 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012904 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012905 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12906 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12907 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12908 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12909 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12910 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12911 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12912 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012913
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012914verifyhost <hostname>
12915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012916 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12917 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12918 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12919 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12920 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12921 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12922 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12923 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012925weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012926 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12927 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12928 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012929 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12930 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12931 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12932 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12933 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12934 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012935
12936
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129375.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12938-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012939
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012940HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12941using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12942configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012943This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12944can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12945workload.
12946This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12947resolution at run time.
12948Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12949carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12950
12951
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129525.3.1. Global overview
12953----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012954
12955As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12956different steps of the process life:
12957
12958 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12959 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12960 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12961
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012962 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12963 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012964
12965A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12966 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12967 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12968 resolution to know this new IP.
12969
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012970When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012971HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012972SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12973from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12974will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12975will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012976
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012977A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012978 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012979 first valid response.
12980
12981 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12982 servers return an error.
12983
12984
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129855.3.2. The resolvers section
12986----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012987
12988This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012989HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12990contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012991
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012992When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12993uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12994is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12995answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12996
12997When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012998used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012999
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013000 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13001 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13002 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013003
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013004 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13005 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013006
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013007 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13008 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13009 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013010
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013011For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13012following scenarios are possible:
13013
13014 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13015 ignored
13016
13017 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13018 applied
13019
13020 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13021 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13022
13023 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13024 retries the query with a new type
13025
13026 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13027 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013028
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013029As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13030a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013031<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013032
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013033
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013034resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013035 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013036
13037A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13038
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013039accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013040 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013041 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013042 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13043 by RFC 6891)
13044
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013045 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13046
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013047nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13048 DNS server description:
13049 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13050 <ip> : IP address of the server
13051 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13052
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013053parse-resolv-conf
13054 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13055 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13056 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13057
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013058hold <status> <period>
13059 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13060 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013061 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013062 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013063 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13064 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13065 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13066
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013067 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013068
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013069resolve_retries <nb>
13070 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13071 giving up.
13072 Default value: 3
13073
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013074 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13075 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13076 type.
13077
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013078timeout <event> <time>
13079 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13080 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13081 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013082 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13083 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013084 Default value: 1s
13085 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013086 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013087 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013088 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13089 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13090
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013091 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013092
13093 resolvers mydns
13094 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13095 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013096 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013097 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013098 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013099 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013100 hold other 30s
13101 hold refused 30s
13102 hold nx 30s
13103 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013104 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013105 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013106
13107
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200131086. Cache
13109---------
13110
13111HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13112(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13113RAM.
13114
13115The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13116this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13117
13118If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13119independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13120when we try to allocate a new one.
13121
13122The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13123
13124It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13125"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13126for more details.
13127
13128When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13129replaced by "<CACHE>".
13130
13131
131326.1. Limitation
13133----------------
13134
13135The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13136
13137- If the response is not a 200
13138- If the response contains a Vary header
13139- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13140- If the response is not cacheable
13141
13142- If the request is not a GET
13143- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13144- If the request contains an Authorization header
13145
13146
131476.2. Setup
13148-----------
13149
13150To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13151the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13152
13153
131546.2.1. Cache section
13155---------------------
13156
13157cache <name>
13158 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13159 size of cache is mandatory.
13160
13161total-max-size <megabytes>
13162 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13163 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13164
13165max-object-size <bytes>
13166 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13167 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13168 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13169
13170max-age <seconds>
13171 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13172 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13173 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13174 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13175 default.
13176
13177
131786.2.2. Proxy section
13179---------------------
13180
13181http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13182 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13183 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13184 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13185 after this one.
13186
13187http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13188 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13189 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13190 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13191 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13192
13193
13194Example:
13195
13196 backend bck1
13197 mode http
13198
13199 http-request cache-use foobar
13200 http-response cache-store foobar
13201 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13202
13203 cache foobar
13204 total-max-size 4
13205 max-age 240
13206
13207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132087. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13209----------------------------------
13210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013211HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13213The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13214these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13215but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13216data called patterns.
13217
13218
132197.1. ACL basics
13220---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013221
13222The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13223content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13224from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13225simple :
13226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013228 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13230 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013232The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13233adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013234
13235In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013238
13239This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13240Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13241and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013242an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13243conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13244as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13245are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013246
13247ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13248'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13249which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13250
13251There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13252performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13255specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13256this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013257methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13258ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013259
13260Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13261 - boolean
13262 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13263 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13264 - string
13265 - data block
13266
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013267Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13268converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13269would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13270The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13271which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13272
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013273Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13274keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13275fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13276which are summarized in the table below :
13277
13278 +---------------------+-----------------+
13279 | Sample or converter | Default |
13280 | output type | matching method |
13281 +---------------------+-----------------+
13282 | boolean | bool |
13283 +---------------------+-----------------+
13284 | integer | int |
13285 +---------------------+-----------------+
13286 | ip | ip |
13287 +---------------------+-----------------+
13288 | string | str |
13289 +---------------------+-----------------+
13290 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13291 +---------------------+-----------------+
13292
13293Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13294matching method, see below.
13295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13297 - boolean
13298 - integer or integer range
13299 - IP address / network
13300 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13301 - regular expression
13302 - hex block
13303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013304The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13305
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013306 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13307 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013309 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013310 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013311 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013312 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013314The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13315read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13316if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13317lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13318will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13319beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13320a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13321lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13322exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13323
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013324The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13325parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13326ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13327a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13328check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13329
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013330The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13331socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13332file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13335loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13336
13337 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13338
13339In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13340the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13341case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13342as well.
13343
13344The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13345sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13346do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13347methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13348is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13351default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13352that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13353string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13354
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013355The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13356By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13357string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13358resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13359server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013360waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013361flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13362function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13365sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13366be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013367
13368 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13369 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13371 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13372 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13373 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013374
13375 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13376 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013378
13379 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013381
13382 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013384
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013385 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013386 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13387
13388 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13389 binary or string samples.
13390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013391 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13392 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013394 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13395 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13396 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13399 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013401 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13402 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13405 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013407 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13408 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013409 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13412 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13413 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013414
13415For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13416request, it is possible to do :
13417
13418 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13419
13420In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13421buffer, one would use the following acl :
13422
13423 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13424
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013425On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13426possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13427
13428 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13431criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13432method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13433to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13434criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13435the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013438the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13439For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13442 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13443 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13444 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013445
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013446
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013447The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13448types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13449combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13450brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13451default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453 +-------------------------------------------------+
13454 | Input sample type |
13455 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013456 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13458 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13459 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013460 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013462 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013464 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013466 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013468 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013470 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013472 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013474 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013476 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013477 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013478 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013479 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013480 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13482 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13483 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013484
13485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134867.1.1. Matching booleans
13487------------------------
13488
13489In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13490Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13491When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13492that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13493
13494Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13495return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13496"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134997.1.2. Matching integers
13500------------------------
13501
13502Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13503enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13504to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13505
13506Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13507matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13508lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013509
13510For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13511unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13512representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13513
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013514As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13515two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13516instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13517ranges and operators.
13518
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013519For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013520operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13521Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13522of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013524Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013525
13526 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13527 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13528 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13529 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13530 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013532For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013533
13534 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13535
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013536This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13537
13538 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13539
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135417.1.3. Matching strings
13542-----------------------
13543
13544String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13545different forms :
13546
13547 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013548 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013549
13550 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013551 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552
13553 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13554 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13555
13556 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13557 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13558
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013559 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013560 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13561 matches.
13562
13563 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13564 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13565 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013566
13567String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13568exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13569characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13570string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13571to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013572before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013573
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013574Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13575(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13576Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13577
13578Example:
13579 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13580 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13581
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13584---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013585
13586Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13587they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13588possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13589passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13590the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013591the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13592match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013593
13594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135957.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13596-------------------------------------
13597
13598It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13599not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13600a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13601to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13602digits may be used upper or lower case.
13603
13604Example :
13605 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13606 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13607
13608
136097.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13610---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013611
13612IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13613netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13614within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013615host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013616difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13617at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13618does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13619parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013620
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013621The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13622abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13623
13624 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13625 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13626 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13627 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13628 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13629 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13630 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13631 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13632
13633Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13634192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13635
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013636IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13637Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13638trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13639IPv6 patterns.
13640
13641HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13642following situations :
13643 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13644 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13645 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13646 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13647 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13648 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13649 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13650 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13651 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13652 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654
136557.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13656----------------------------------
13657
13658Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13659combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13660
13661 - AND (implicit)
13662 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13663 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013665A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013667 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013669Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13670indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013672For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13673"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13674requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13675is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13676
13677 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013678 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13679 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13680 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013681
13682To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13683and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13684
13685 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13686 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13687 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13688 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13689
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013690 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013691 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13692 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13693 use_backend www if host_www
13694
13695It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13696expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13697be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13698the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13699
13700 The following rule :
13701
13702 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013703 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013704
13705 Can also be written that way :
13706
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013707 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708
13709It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13710to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13711simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13712sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13713good use is the following :
13714
13715 With named ACLs :
13716
13717 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13718 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13719 monitor fail if site_dead
13720
13721 With anonymous ACLs :
13722
13723 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13724
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013725See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13726keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013727
13728
137297.3. Fetching samples
13730---------------------
13731
13732Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13733against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13734sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13735ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13736of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13737available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13738
13739This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13740Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13741compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13742deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13743
13744The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13745matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13746method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13747indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13748
13749As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13750when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13751mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13752the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13753ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13754
13755Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13756multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13757when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013758incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13759are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13761all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13762
13763Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13764 - name
13765 - name(arg1)
13766 - name(arg1,arg2)
13767
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013768
137697.3.1. Converters
13770-----------------
13771
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013772Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13773of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13774is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13775was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013776has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013777unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13778
13779These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13780sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13781the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013782support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013783
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013784A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13785support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13786supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13787(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13788bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013791
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001379251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13793 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13794 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13795 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13796 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13797 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13798
13799 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013800 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13801 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013802 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13803 frontend http-in
13804 bind *:8081
13805 default_backend servers
13806 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13807 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13808
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013809add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013810 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013811 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013812 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13813 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013814 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013815 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13816 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13817 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13818 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013819 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013820 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013821
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013822aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13823 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13824 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13825 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13826 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13827 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13828 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13829
13830 Example:
13831 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13832 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013834and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013835 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013836 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013837 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13838 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013839 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013840 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13841 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13842 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13843 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013844 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013845 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013846
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013847b64dec
13848 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13849 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13850
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013851base64
13852 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013853 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013854 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13855
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013856bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013857 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013858 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013859 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013860 presence of a flag).
13861
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013862bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13863 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13864 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013865 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013866
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013867concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13868 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13869 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13870 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13871 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13872 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13873 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13874 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13875 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13876 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13877 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013878 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
13879 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
13880 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
13881 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013882
13883 Example:
13884 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13885 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13886 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013887 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013888 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13889
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013890cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013891 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13892 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013893
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013894crc32([<avalanche>])
13895 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13896 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13897 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13898 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13899 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13900 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13901 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13902 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13903 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13904 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013905 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13906
13907crc32c([<avalanche>])
13908 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13909 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13910 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13911 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13912 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13913 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13914 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13915 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013916
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013917da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013918 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13919 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13920 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13921 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013922 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013923 configuration language.
13924
13925 Example:
13926 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013927 bind *:8881
13928 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013929 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013930
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013931debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13932 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13933 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13934 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13935 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13936 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13937 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13938 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13939 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13940 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13941 printable sample types.
13942
13943 Example:
13944 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013945
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013946div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013947 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13948 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013949 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013950 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13951 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013952 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013953 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13954 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13955 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13956 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013957 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013958 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013959
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013960djb2([<avalanche>])
13961 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13962 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13963 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13964 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13965 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13966 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13967 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013968 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13969 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013970
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013971even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013972 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013973 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13974
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013975field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13976 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13977 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13978 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13979 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13980 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13981 fields.
13982
13983 Example :
13984 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13985 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13986 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13987 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13988 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013989
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013990hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013991 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013992 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013993 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013994 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013995
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013996hex2i
13997 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013998 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013999
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014000http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014001 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14002 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014003 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14004 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14005 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14006 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14007 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14008 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14009 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14010 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014012in_table(<table>)
14013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14015 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014016 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014017 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14018
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014019ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14020 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014021 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014022 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14023 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14024 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14025 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14026 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014027
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014028json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014029 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014030 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014031 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014032 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14033 of errors:
14034 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14035 bytes, ...)
14036 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14037 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14038
14039 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14040 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14041 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14042 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14043 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14044 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 - "ascii" : never fails;
14046 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14047 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014048 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014049 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014050 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14051 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14052
14053 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014054 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014055
14056 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014057 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014058 capture request header user-agent len 150
14059 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014060
14061 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14062 GET / HTTP/1.0
14063 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14064
14065 Output log:
14066 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14067
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014068language(<value>[,<default>])
14069 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14070 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14071 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14072 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14073 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14074 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14075 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14076 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14077 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014078 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014079 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14080 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014081
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014082 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014084 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14085 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014087 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14088 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14089 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14090 use_backend spanish if es
14091 use_backend french if fr
14092 use_backend english if en
14093 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014094
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014095length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014096 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14097 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14098 type. The result is of type integer.
14099
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014100lower
14101 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14102 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14103 type. The result is of type string.
14104
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014105ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14106 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14107 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14108 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14109 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14110 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14111 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14112
14113 Example :
14114
14115 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014116 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014117 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14118
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014119map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14120map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14121map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14122 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14123 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14124 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14125 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14126 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14127 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14128 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14129 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014130
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014131 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14132 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14133 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014134
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014135 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014136 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014138 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14139 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14140 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14141 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014142 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14143 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014144 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14145 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14146 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14147 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14148 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14149 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14150 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14151 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014152 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14153 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14154 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014155 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14156 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14157 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14158 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14159 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014160
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014161 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14162 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14163 the corresponding match text.
14164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014165 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14166 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14167 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14168 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14169 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014170
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014171 Example :
14172
14173 # this is a comment and is ignored
14174 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14175 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14176 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14177 | | | `---------- value
14178 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14179 | `---------------------------- key
14180 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14181
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014182mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014183 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14184 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014185 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014186 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014187 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014188 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14189 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14191 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014192 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014193 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014194
14195mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014196 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014197 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14198 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014199 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014200 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014201 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014202 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14203 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14204 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14205 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014206 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014207 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014208
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014209nbsrv
14210 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14211 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14212 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14213 map lookup.
14214
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014215neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014216 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14217 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14218 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14219 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014220
14221not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014222 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014223 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014224 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014225 absence of a flag).
14226
14227odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014228 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014229 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14230
14231or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014232 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014233 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014234 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14235 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014236 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014237 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14238 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14239 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14240 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014241 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014242 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014243
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014244protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14245 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14246 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14247 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14248 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14249 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14250 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14251 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14252 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14253 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14254 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14255 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14256
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014257regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014258 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14259 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14260 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14261 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14262 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14263 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14264 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14265 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14266 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014267 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14268 of characters with other ones.
14269
14270 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14271 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14272 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14273 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14274 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14275 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014276
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014277 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014278
14279 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14280 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14281 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014282 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014283
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014284 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14285 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14286
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014287 # capture groups and backreferences
14288 # both lines do the same.
14289 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14290 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14291
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014292capture-req(<id>)
14293 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14294 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14295
14296 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014297 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14298 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014299
14300capture-res(<id>)
14301 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14302 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14303
14304 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014305 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14306 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014307
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014308sdbm([<avalanche>])
14309 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14310 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14311 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14312 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14313 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14314 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14315 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014316 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14317 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014318
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014319set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014320 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14321 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14322 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014323 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014324 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14325 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014326 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014327 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14328 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014330 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014331
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014332sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014333 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014334 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14335
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014336sha2([<bits>])
14337 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14338 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14339
14340 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14341 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14342
14343 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14344 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14345
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014346srv_queue
14347 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14348 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14349 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14350 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14351 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14352
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014353strcmp(<var>)
14354 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14355 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14356 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14357 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14358 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14359 shorter).
14360
14361 Example :
14362
14363 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14364 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14365 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14366
14367
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014368sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014369 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14370 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014371 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014372 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14373 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014374 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014375 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14376 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014377 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014378 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14379 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014380 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014381 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014382
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014383table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14387 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14388 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14389 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14390
14391
14392table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14393 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14394 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14395 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14396 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14397 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14398 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14399
14400table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14401 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14402 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014403 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014404 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14405 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14406
14407table_conn_cur(<table>)
14408 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14409 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14410 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14411 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14412 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14413
14414table_conn_rate(<table>)
14415 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14416 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14417 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14418 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14419 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14420
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014421table_gpt0(<table>)
14422 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14423 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14424 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14425 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14426 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14427
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014428table_gpc0(<table>)
14429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14432 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14433 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14434
14435table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14436 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14437 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14438 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14439 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14440 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14441 sample fetch keyword.
14442
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014443table_gpc1(<table>)
14444 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14445 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14446 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14447 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14448 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14449
14450table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14453 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14454 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14455 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14456 sample fetch keyword.
14457
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014458table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14459 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14460 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014461 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014462 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14463 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14464
14465table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14468 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14469 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14470 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14471 keyword.
14472
14473table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014477 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14478 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14479
14480table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14481 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14482 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14483 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14484 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14485 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14486 keyword.
14487
14488table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14489 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14490 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014491 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014492 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14493 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14494 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14495 keyword.
14496
14497table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14498 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14499 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014500 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014501 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14502 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14503 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14504 keyword.
14505
14506table_server_id(<table>)
14507 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14508 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14509 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14510 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14511 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14512 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14513
14514table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14515 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14516 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014517 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014518 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14519 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14520 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14521 keyword.
14522
14523table_sess_rate(<table>)
14524 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14525 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14526 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14527 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14528 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14529 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14530 keyword.
14531
14532table_trackers(<table>)
14533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14536 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14537 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14538 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14539 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14540 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14541 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14542 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14543
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014544upper
14545 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14546 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14547 type. The result is of type string.
14548
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014549url_dec([<in_form>])
14550 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14551 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14552 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14553 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14554 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14555 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014556
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014557ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014558 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014559 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14560 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14561 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014562 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14563 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14564 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14565 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014566 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014567 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14568 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014569
14570 Example:
14571 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14572 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14573
14574 message Point {
14575 int32 latitude = 1;
14576 int32 longitude = 2;
14577 }
14578
14579 message PPoint {
14580 Point point = 59;
14581 }
14582
14583 message Rectangle {
14584 // One corner of the rectangle.
14585 PPoint lo = 48;
14586 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14587 PPoint hi = 49;
14588 }
14589
14590 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14591 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14592 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14593
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014594 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14595 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014596 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014597 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14598
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014599 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014600
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014601 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014602
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014603 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014604 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14605 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14606
14607 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14608 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14609 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14610
14611 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14612 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14613 interpret the previous binary sample.
14614
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014615
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014616unset-var(<var name>)
14617 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14618 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14619 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14620 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14621 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14622 response),
14623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14627
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014628utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14629 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14630 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14631 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14632 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14633 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14634 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14635
14636 Example :
14637
14638 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014639 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014640 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14641
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014642word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14643 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14644 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14645 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014646 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014647 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14648 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14649
14650 Example :
14651 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14652 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14653 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14654 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14655 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014656 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014657
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014658wt6([<avalanche>])
14659 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14660 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14661 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14662 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14663 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14664 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14665 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014666 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14667 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014668
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014669xor(<value>)
14670 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014671 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014672 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014673 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014674 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014675 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14676 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014677 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014678 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14679 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014680 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014681 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014682
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014683xxh32([<seed>])
14684 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14685 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14686 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14687 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14688 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14689 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14690 as cryptographically secure.
14691
14692xxh64([<seed>])
14693 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14694 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14695 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14696 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14697 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14698 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14699 as cryptographically secure.
14700
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014701
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147027.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014703--------------------------------------------
14704
14705A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14706not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14707"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14708The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14709
14710always_false : boolean
14711 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14712 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14713
14714always_true : boolean
14715 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14716 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14717
14718avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014719 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14721 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14722 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14723 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14724 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14725 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14726 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14727 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14728 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14729 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14730 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14731 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14732 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014734be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014735 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14736 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14737 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14738 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014739 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14740
14741be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14743 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14744 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14745 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14746 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014747 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14748 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014749
14750 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14751 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14752 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14756 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14757 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014758 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14760 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014761
14762 Example :
14763 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14764 backend dynamic
14765 mode http
14766 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14767 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014769bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014770 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14771 of the string.
14772
14773bool(<bool>) : bool
14774 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14775 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14778 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014779 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14781 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014782
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014783 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014784 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014785 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014787 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14788 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014789
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014790 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014791 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014793 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014794 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014796 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014797
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014798 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14799 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014801 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014802
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014803cpu_calls : integer
14804 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14805 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14806 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14807 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14808 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14809 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14810
14811cpu_ns_avg : integer
14812 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14813 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14814 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14815 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14816 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14817 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14818 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14819 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14820 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14821 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14822 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14823
14824cpu_ns_tot : integer
14825 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14826 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14827 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14828 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14829 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14830 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14831 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14832 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14833 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14834 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14835 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14836 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14837 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14838
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014839date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014840 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014841
14842 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14843 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14844 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014845 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14846
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014847 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14848 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14849 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14850 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14851 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14852
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014853 Example :
14854
14855 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14856 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014857
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014858 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14859 # millisecond granularity
14860 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14861
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014862date_us : integer
14863 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14864 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14865 from the same timeval structure.
14866
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014867distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14868 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14869 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14870 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14871 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14872 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14873 list of supported tokens.
14874
14875distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14876 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14877 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14878 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14879 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14880 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14881 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14882 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14883 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14884 supported tokens.
14885
14886 Example :
14887 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14888 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14889 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14890 # send large files to the big farm
14891 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14892
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014893env(<name>) : string
14894 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14895 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14896 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14897 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14898 certain way.
14899
14900 Examples :
14901 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14902 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14903
14904 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14905 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14908 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014909 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14910 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14912 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014913 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14915 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014916
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014917fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14918 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14919 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14920 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14923 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14924 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14925 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14926 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14927 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14928 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14929 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14930 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014931
14932 Example :
14933 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14934 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14935 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14936 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14937 frontend mail
14938 bind :25
14939 mode tcp
14940 maxconn 100
14941 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14942 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14943 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14944 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014945
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014946hostname : string
14947 Returns the system hostname.
14948
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014949int(<integer>) : signed integer
14950 Returns a signed integer.
14951
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014952ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14953 Returns an ipv4.
14954
14955ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14956 Returns an ipv6.
14957
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014958lat_ns_avg : integer
14959 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14960 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14961 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14962 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14963 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14964 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14965 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14966 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14967 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14968 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14969 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14970 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14971 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14972 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14973
14974lat_ns_tot : integer
14975 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14976 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14977 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14978 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14979 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14980 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14981 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14982 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14983 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14984 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14985 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14986 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14987 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14988 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14989 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14990 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14991 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14992 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14993 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14994
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014995meth(<method>) : method
14996 Returns a method.
14997
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014998nbproc : integer
14999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15000 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15001 and debugging purposes.
15002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15004 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15005 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15006 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015007 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15008 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15009 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015010
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015011prio_class : integer
15012 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15013 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15014 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15015
15016prio_offset : integer
15017 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15018 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15019 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15020 set-priority-offset".
15021
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015022proc : integer
15023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15024 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15025 debugging purposes.
15026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015028 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15029 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15030 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15032 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15033 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15034 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15035 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15036
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015037rand([<range>]) : integer
15038 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15039 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15040 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15041 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15042 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15043
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015044uuid([<version>]) : string
15045 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15046 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15047 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015049srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15051 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15052 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15053 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15054 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015055 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15056 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15057
15058srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15059 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15060 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15061 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15062 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15063 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15064 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15065 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15066
15067 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15068 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069
15070srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15071 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15072 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15073 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015074 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15076 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15077 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15078
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015079srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15081 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15082 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15083 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15084 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15085 fetch methods.
15086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15088 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15089 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015090 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15092 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015093 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094 overloading servers).
15095
15096 Example :
15097 # Redirect to a separate back
15098 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15099 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15100 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15101
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015102stopping : boolean
15103 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15104 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15105 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15106
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015107str(<string>) : string
15108 Returns a string.
15109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15111 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15112 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15113
15114table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15115 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15116 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15117 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15118
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015119thread : integer
15120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15121 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15122 and debugging purposes.
15123
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015124var(<var-name>) : undefined
15125 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015126 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15127 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015128 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015129 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15130 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015131 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015132 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15133 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015134 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015135 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015136
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151377.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138----------------------------------
15139
15140The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15141closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15142methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15143sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15144TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015145the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15146counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015147"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15148used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15149can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15150Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15151table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15152tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15153currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015154
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015155bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015156 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15157 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15158 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160be_id : integer
15161 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15162 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15163
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015164be_name : string
15165 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15166 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168dst : ip
15169 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15170 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15171 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15172 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015173 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15174 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15175 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15176 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15177 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15178 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015179
15180dst_conn : integer
15181 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15182 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15183 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15184 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15185 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15186 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15187 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15188 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015189
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015190dst_is_local : boolean
15191 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15192 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15193 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15194 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015195 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015196 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15197 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15198 it only once per connection.
15199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200dst_port : integer
15201 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15202 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15203 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15204 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15205 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15206 an HTTP header.
15207
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015208fc_http_major : integer
15209 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15210 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15211 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15212
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015213fc_pp_authority : string
15214 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15215 if any.
15216
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015217fc_pp_unique_id : string
15218 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15219 if any.
15220
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015221fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15222 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15223 header.
15224
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015225fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15226 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15227 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15228 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15229 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15230 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15231 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15232
15233fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15234 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15235 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15236 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15237 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15238 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15239 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15240
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015241fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015242 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15243 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15244 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15245 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15246
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015247fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015248 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15249 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15250 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15251 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15252
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015253fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015254 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15255 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15256 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15257 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15258
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015259fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015260 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15261 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15262 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15263 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15264
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015265fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015266 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15267 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15268 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15269 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15270
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015271fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015272 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15273 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15274 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15275 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15276
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015277fe_defbe : string
15278 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15279 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281fe_id : integer
15282 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015283 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15285
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015286fe_name : string
15287 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15288 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15289 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015291sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015292sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15293sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15294sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015295 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15296 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15297 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15298
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015299sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015300sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15301sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15302sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015303 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15304 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15305 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15306
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015307sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015308sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15309sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15310sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015311 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15312 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015313 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15314 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15315 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015316
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015317 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015318 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15319 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015320 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15321 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15322 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015323 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15324 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15325
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015326sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15327sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15328sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15329sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15330 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15331 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15332 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15333 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15334 when a first ACL was verified.
15335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015336sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015337sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15338sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15339sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015340 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015341 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015343sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015344sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15345sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15346sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015347 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15348 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15349 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15350
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015351sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015352sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15353sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15354sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015355 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15356 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15357 See also src_conn_rate.
15358
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015359sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015360sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15361sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15362sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015363 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015364 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015365
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015366sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15367sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15368sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15369sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15370 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15371 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15372
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015373sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15374sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15375sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15376sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15377 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15378 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15379
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015380sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015381sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15382sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15383sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015384 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15385 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15386 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015387 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15388 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15389 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015390
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015391sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15392sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15393sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15396 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15397 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15398 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15399 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15400 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015402sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015403sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15404sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15405sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015406 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015407 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15408 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015410sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015411sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15412sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15413sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015414 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15415 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15416 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15417 src_http_err_rate.
15418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015419sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015420sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15421sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15422sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015423 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015424 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15425 src_http_req_cnt.
15426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015427sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015428sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15429sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15430sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015431 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15432 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15433 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15434 src_http_req_rate.
15435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015436sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015437sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15438sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15439sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015441 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15442 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15443 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15444 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015445
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015446 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015447 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15448 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015449 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15450
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015451sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15452sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15453sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15454sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15455 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15456 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15457 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15458 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15459 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015461sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015462sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15463sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15464sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015465 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15466 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15467 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015469sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015470sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15471sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15472sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015473 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15474 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15475 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015477sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015478sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15479sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15480sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015481 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015482 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15483 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15484 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015485 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015486 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015488sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015489sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15490sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15491sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015492 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15493 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15494 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15495 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15496 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015497 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015499sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015500sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15501sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15502sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015503 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15504 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15505 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015507sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015508sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15509sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15510sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015511 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15512 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015513 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015514 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15515 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15517 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15518 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520so_id : integer
15521 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15522 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15523 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015524
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015525so_name : string
15526 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15527 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15528 strings instead of integers.
15529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015531 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15533 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15534 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015535 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15536 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15537 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015538 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15539 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15540 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15541 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15542 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15543 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15544 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015545
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015546 Example:
15547 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15548 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15551 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15552 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15553 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015554 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15557 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15558 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015559 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015560 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15563 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15564 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15565 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15566 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15567 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15568 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015569
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015570 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015571 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15572 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15573 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15574 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015575 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015576 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15577 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15578
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015579src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15580 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15581 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15582 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15583 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15584 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15585 was verified.
15586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015588 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015590 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015591 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015594 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15596 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015597 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15600 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15601 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15602 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015603 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015606 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015609 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015611src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15612 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15613 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15614 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15615 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15616
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015617src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15618 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15619 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15620 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15621 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015624 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015626 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15627 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015628 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15629 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15630 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015632src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15633 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15634 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15636 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15637 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15638 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15639 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015644 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015645 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15649 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15650 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15651 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15652 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015653 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015656 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15658 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015659 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15662 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15663 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15664 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015665 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015666 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15669 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15670 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15671 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015672 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15674 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015675
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015676 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015677 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015678 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015679 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015680
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015681src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15682 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15683 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15684 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15685 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15686 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15687 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15688
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015689src_is_local : boolean
15690 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15691 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15692 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15693 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015694 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015695 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15696 once per connection.
15697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015699 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15700 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15701 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15702 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15703 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015706 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15707 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15708 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15709 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15710 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712src_port : integer
15713 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15714 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15715 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15716 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015719 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015720 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15721 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15722 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015723 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15726 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15727 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15728 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15729 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015730 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15733 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15734 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15735 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15736 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15737 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15738 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15739 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15740 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015741
15742 Example :
15743 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15744 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15745 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15746 listen ssh
15747 bind :22
15748 mode tcp
15749 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015750 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015752 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754srv_id : integer
15755 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15756 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15757 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015758
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015759srv_name : string
15760 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15761 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15762 debugging.
15763
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157647.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15768closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15769when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15770usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015771future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015772
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001577351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15774 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15775 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15776 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15777 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15778 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15779
15780 Example :
15781 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15782 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15783 # the request.
15784 frontend http-in
15785 bind *:8081
15786 default_backend servers
15787 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15788 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15789
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015790ssl_bc : boolean
15791 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15792 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15793 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15794
15795ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15796 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15797 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15798
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015799ssl_bc_alpn : string
15800 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15801 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015802 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015803 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15804 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15805 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15806 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15807 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15808 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15809
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015810ssl_bc_cipher : string
15811 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15812 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15813
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015814ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15815 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15816 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15817 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15818
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015819ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15820 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15821 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15822 session or a TLS ticket.
15823
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015824ssl_bc_npn : string
15825 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15826 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015827 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015828 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15829 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15830 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15831 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15832 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15833
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015834ssl_bc_protocol : string
15835 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15836 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15837
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015838ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015839 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015840 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15841 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015842
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015843ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15844 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15845 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15846 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15847
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015848ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15849 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15850 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15851 if session was reused or not.
15852
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015853ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15854 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15855 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15856 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15857 BoringSSL.
15858
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015859ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15860 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15861 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15864 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15865 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15866 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15867 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15868 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15871 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15872 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15873 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15874 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015875
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015876ssl_c_der : binary
15877 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15879 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881ssl_c_err : integer
15882 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15883 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15884 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15885 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15886 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015887
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015888ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15890 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15891 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15892 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15893 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15894 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15895 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15896 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015897 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15898 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15899 LDAP v3.
15900 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15901 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903ssl_c_key_alg : string
15904 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15905 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15906 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908ssl_c_notafter : string
15909 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15910 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15911 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913ssl_c_notbefore : string
15914 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15915 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15916 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015917
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015918ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15920 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15921 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15922 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15923 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15924 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15925 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15926 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015927 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15928 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15929 LDAP v3.
15930 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15931 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933ssl_c_serial : binary
15934 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15935 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15936 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15939 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15940 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15941 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015942 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15943 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15944
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015945 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015946 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15949 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15950 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15951 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953ssl_c_used : boolean
15954 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15955 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957ssl_c_verify : integer
15958 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15959 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15960 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15961 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963ssl_c_version : integer
15964 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15965 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015966
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015967ssl_f_der : binary
15968 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15969 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15970 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15971
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015972ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15974 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15975 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15976 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015977 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15979 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15980 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015981 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15982 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15983 LDAP v3.
15984 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15985 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987ssl_f_key_alg : string
15988 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15989 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15990 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992ssl_f_notafter : string
15993 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15994 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15995 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997ssl_f_notbefore : string
15998 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15999 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16000 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016001
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016002ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16004 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16005 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16006 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16007 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16008 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16009 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16010 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016011 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16012 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16013 LDAP v3.
16014 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16015 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017ssl_f_serial : binary
16018 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16019 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16020 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016021
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016022ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16023 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16024 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16025 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16028 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16029 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16030 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032ssl_f_version : integer
16033 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16034 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16035
16036ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016037 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16038 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16039 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 Example :
16042 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16043 listen http-https
16044 bind :80
16045 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16046 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16047
16048ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16049 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16050 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16051
16052ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016053 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16055 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16056 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16057 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16058 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16059 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16060 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16061 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063ssl_fc_cipher : string
16064 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16065 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016066
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016067ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16068 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16069 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016070 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016071
16072ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16073 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16074 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016075 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016076
16077ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16078 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16079 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16080 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016081 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016082 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016083
16084ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16085 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16086 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016087 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016088
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016089ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16090 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16091 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16092 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016095 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16096 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016097 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16098 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16099 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16100 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016101
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016102ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16103 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16104 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16105 wait until the handshake happened.
16106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16108 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016109 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16110 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016111 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016112 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016113
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016114ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016115 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016116 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16117 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016120 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16122 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16123 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16124 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16125 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16126 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16127 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129ssl_fc_protocol : string
16130 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16131 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016132
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016133ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016134 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016135 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16136 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016137
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016138ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16139 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16140 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16141 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16144 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16145 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16146 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16147 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016148
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016149ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16150 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16151 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16152 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16153 BoringSSL.
16154
16155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156ssl_fc_sni : string
16157 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16158 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16159 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16160 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16161 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16162
16163 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16164 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16165 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016166 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016167 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16171 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16174 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16175 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016176
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016177
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16182sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16183only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16184For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16185be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16186can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16187sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16188for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16189content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016192 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16194 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016196payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16197 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016198 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016200
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016201req.hdrs : string
16202 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16203 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16204 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16205 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16206
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016207req.hdrs_bin : binary
16208 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16209 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16210 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16211 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16212 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16213 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16214
16215 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16216
16217 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16218 str: <int:length><bytes>
16219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220req.len : integer
16221req_len : integer (deprecated)
16222 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16223 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16224 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16225 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16226 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16227 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16228 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16229 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16232 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016233 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16234 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16235 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16236 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238 ACL alternatives :
16239 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16242 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16243 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16244 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16245 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 ACL alternatives :
16248 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252req.proto_http : boolean
16253req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16254 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16255 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16256 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16257 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16258 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16259 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16260 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262 Example:
16263 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16264 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16265 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016266 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16269rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16270 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16271 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16272 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16273 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16274 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16275 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16276 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16279 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16280 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16281 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16282 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16283 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285 ACL derivatives :
16286 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016288 Example :
16289 listen tse-farm
16290 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16291 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16292 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16293 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16294 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16295 persist rdp-cookie
16296 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16297 # This is only useful makes sense if
16298 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16299 stick-table type string size 204800
16300 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16301 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16302 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016304 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16305 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16308rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16309 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16310 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16311 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16312 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016314 ACL derivatives :
16315 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016316
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016317req.ssl_alpn : string
16318 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16319 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16320 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16321 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16322 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16323 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016324 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016325
16326 Examples :
16327 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16328 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16329 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016330 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016331 default_backend bk_default
16332
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016333req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16334 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16335 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016336 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16337 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16338 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16339 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16340 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16343req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16344 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16345 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16346 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16347 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16348 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16349 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16350 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352req.ssl_sni : string
16353req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16354 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16355 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16356 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16357 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16358 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16359 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16360 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16361 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16362 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16363 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16364 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16365 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016367 ACL derivatives :
16368 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370 Examples :
16371 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16372 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16373 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16374 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16375 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016376
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016377req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16378 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16379 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16380 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16381 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16382 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16383 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16384 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16385 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16386 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388req.ssl_ver : integer
16389req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16390 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16391 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16392 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16393 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16394 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16395 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16396 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016397 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400 ACL derivatives :
16401 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016402
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016403res.len : integer
16404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16405 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16406 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16407 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16408 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16409 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16410 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16411 content inspection.
16412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16414 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016415 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16416 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16417 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16418 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16421 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16422 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16423 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16424 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016426 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016427
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016428res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16429rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16430 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16431 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16432 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16433 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16434 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16435 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16436 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438wait_end : boolean
16439 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16440 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016441 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16443 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016444 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16446 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448 Examples :
16449 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16450 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16451 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16454 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16455 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16456 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16457 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16458 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16459 tcp-request content reject
16460
16461
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164627.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463--------------------------------------
16464
16465It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16466This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16467data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16468its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16469HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16470content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16471to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16472more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16473response are indexed.
16474
16475base : string
16476 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16477 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16478 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16479 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16480 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16481 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16482 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16483 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16484
16485 ACL derivatives :
16486 base : exact string match
16487 base_beg : prefix match
16488 base_dir : subdir match
16489 base_dom : domain match
16490 base_end : suffix match
16491 base_len : length match
16492 base_reg : regex match
16493 base_sub : substring match
16494
16495base32 : integer
16496 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16497 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16498 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016499 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16500 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16501 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502
16503base32+src : binary
16504 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16505 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16506 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16507 per-URL counters.
16508
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016509capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16510 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16511 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16512 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16513
16514capture.req.method : string
16515 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16516 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16517 because it's allocated.
16518
16519capture.req.uri : string
16520 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16521 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16522 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16523 allocated.
16524
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016525capture.req.ver : string
16526 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16527 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16528 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16529
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016530capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16531 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16532 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16533 The first entry is an index of 0.
16534 See also: "capture response header"
16535
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016536capture.res.ver : string
16537 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16538 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16539 persistent flag.
16540
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016541req.body : binary
16542 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16543 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16544 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16545 the first chunk is analyzed.
16546
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016547req.body_param([<name>) : string
16548 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16549 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16550 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16551 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16552 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16553 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16554 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16555 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16556 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16557 given.
16558
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016559req.body_len : integer
16560 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16561 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16562 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16563 "option http-buffer-request".
16564
16565req.body_size : integer
16566 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16567 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16568 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16569 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16570 "option http-buffer-request".
16571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572req.cook([<name>]) : string
16573cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16574 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16575 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16576 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16577 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16578 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16579 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16580 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16581 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16582
16583 ACL derivatives :
16584 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16585 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16586 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16587 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16588 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16589 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16590 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16591 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16594cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16595 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16596 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16599cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16600 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16601 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16602 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16603 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16606 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16607 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16608 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16609 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016610 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16612 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16613 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16614 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16617 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16618 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16619 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16620 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016621 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16624 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16625 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16626 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16627 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16628 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16629 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16630 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16631 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016633req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16634 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16635 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16636 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16637 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16640 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16641 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16642 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16643 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16644 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16645 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16646 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16647 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016648 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016650 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652 ACL derivatives :
16653 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16654 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16655 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16656 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16657 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16658 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16659 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16660 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16661
16662req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16663hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16664 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16665 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16666 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16667 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16668 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16669 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16670 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16671 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16672 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16673
16674req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16675hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16676 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16677 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16678 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16679 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16680 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16683 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16684
16685req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16686hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16687 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16688 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16689 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16690 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16691 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16692 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16693 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16694
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016695
16696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016697http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16698 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16699 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16700 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16701 basic auth is supported.
16702
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016703http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16704 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16705 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16706 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16707 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016708 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16709 basic auth is supported.
16710
16711 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016712 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16713 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16714 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16715 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016717http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016718 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16719 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16720 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016721
16722http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016723 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16724 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16725 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016726
16727http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016728 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16729 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16730 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016732http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016733 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16734 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16736 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016738method : integer + string
16739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16740 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16741 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16742 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16743 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16744 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16745 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016747 ACL derivatives :
16748 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016750 Example :
16751 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16752 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16753 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016755path : string
16756 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16757 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16758 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16759 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16760 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016761 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016762 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764 ACL derivatives :
16765 path : exact string match
16766 path_beg : prefix match
16767 path_dir : subdir match
16768 path_dom : domain match
16769 path_end : suffix match
16770 path_len : length match
16771 path_reg : regex match
16772 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016773
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016774query : string
16775 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16776 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16777 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16778 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016779 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016780 which stops before the question mark.
16781
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016782req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16783 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16784 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16785 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16786 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788req.ver : string
16789req_ver : string (deprecated)
16790 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16791 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16792 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016794 ACL derivatives :
16795 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797res.comp : boolean
16798 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16799 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16800 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016802res.comp_algo : string
16803 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16804 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16805 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807res.cook([<name>]) : string
16808scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16809 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16810 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16811 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813 ACL derivatives :
16814 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16817scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16818 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16819 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16820 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16823scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16824 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16825 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16826 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16829 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16830 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16831 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16832 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16833 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16834 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16835 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16836 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16837 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16840 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16841 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16842 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16843 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16844 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16847shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16848 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16849 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16850 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16851 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16852 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16853 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16854 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16855 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016857 ACL derivatives :
16858 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16859 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16860 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16861 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16862 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16863 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16864 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16865 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16866
16867res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16868shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16869 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16870 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16871 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16872 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16873 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16876shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16877 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16878 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16879 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16880 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16881 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16882 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016883
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016884res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16885 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16886 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16887 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16888 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16891shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16892 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16893 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16894 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16895 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16896 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16897 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899res.ver : string
16900resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16901 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16902 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904 ACL derivatives :
16905 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016907set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16908 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16909 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016910 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016913 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16914 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916status : integer
16917 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16918 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16919 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016920
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016921unique-id : string
16922 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16923 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16924 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16925 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16926 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16927 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016929url : string
16930 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16931 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16932 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16933 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16934 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16935 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16936 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938 ACL derivatives :
16939 url : exact string match
16940 url_beg : prefix match
16941 url_dir : subdir match
16942 url_dom : domain match
16943 url_end : suffix match
16944 url_len : length match
16945 url_reg : regex match
16946 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016948url_ip : ip
16949 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16950 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16951 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16952 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16953 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16954 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16955 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016957url_port : integer
16958 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16959 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16960 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16961 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016962
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016963urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16964url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016965 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16966 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016967 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16968 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16969 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16970 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16972 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016973 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16974 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016976 ACL derivatives :
16977 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16978 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16979 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16980 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16981 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16982 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16983 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16984 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016985
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016987 Example :
16988 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16989 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16990 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16991 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016992
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016993urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16995 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16996 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016997
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016998url32 : integer
16999 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17000 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17001 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17002 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17003 is an unsigned integer.
17004
17005url32+src : binary
17006 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17007 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17008 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17009
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017010
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100170117.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
17012---------------------------------------
17013
17014This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17015used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17016purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17017There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17018or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17019any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17020for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17021
17022internal.htx.data : integer
17023 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17024 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17025
17026internal.htx.free : integer
17027 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17028 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17029
17030internal.htx.free_data : integer
17031 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17032 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17033
17034internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17035 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17036 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17037 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17038
17039internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17040 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17041 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17042
17043internal.htx.size : integer
17044 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17045 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17046
17047internal.htx.used : integer
17048 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17049 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17050 direction.
17051
17052internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17053 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17054 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17055 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17056 of the special value :
17057 * head : The oldest inserted block
17058 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017059 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017060
17061internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17062 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17063 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17064 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17065 integer or one of the special value :
17066 * head : The oldest inserted block
17067 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017068 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017069
17070internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17071 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17072 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17073 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17074 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17075
17076 * head : The oldest inserted block
17077 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017078 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017079
17080internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17081 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17082 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17083 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17084 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17085
17086 * head : The oldest inserted block
17087 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017088 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017089
17090internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17091 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17092 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17093 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17094 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17095
17096 * head : The oldest inserted block
17097 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017098 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017099
17100internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17101 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17102 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17103 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17104 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17105
17106 * head : The oldest inserted block
17107 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017108 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017109
17110internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17111 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17112 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17113 it returns false.
17114
17115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017117---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017119Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17120every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017121order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017123ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17124---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017125FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017126HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017127HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17128HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017129HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17130HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17131HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17132HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17133LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017134METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017135METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017136METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17137METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17138METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17139METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017140METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017141METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017142RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017143REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017144TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017145WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17146---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017147
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171498. Logging
17150----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017152One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17153provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17154very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17155provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17156state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017157to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017158headers.
17159
17160In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17161about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17162send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17163
17164 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17165 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17166 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17167 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17168 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017169 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017170 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017171
17172The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17173allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17174as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17175while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17176real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17177delay.
17178
17179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171808.1. Log levels
17181---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017182
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017183TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017184source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017185HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17186in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17187track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17188syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17189about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017190
17191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171928.2. Log formats
17193----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017194
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017195HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017196and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17197slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17198options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199
17200 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17201 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17202 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17203 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17204 extents.
17205
17206 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17207 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17208 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17209 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17210 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17211
17212 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17213 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17214 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17215 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17216 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17217
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017218 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17219 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17220 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17221 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17222
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017223 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17224
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17226specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17227field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17228servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17229always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17230identifier.
17231
17232Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17233 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17234 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17235 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17236 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17237
17238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172398.2.1. Default log format
17240-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017241
17242This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17243as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17244format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17245
17246 Example :
17247 listen www
17248 mode http
17249 log global
17250 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17251
17252 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17253 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17254 (www/HTTP)
17255
17256 Field Format Extract from the example above
17257 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17258 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17259 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17260 4 'to' to
17261 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17262 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17263
17264Detailed fields description :
17265 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17266 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17267 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17268 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17269 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17270 and processed the connection.
17271 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17272
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017273In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17274"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17275connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17276
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017277It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17278will eventually disappear.
17279
17280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172818.2.2. TCP log format
17282---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017283
17284The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17285is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17286information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17287counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17288emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17289environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17290the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17291sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017292specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17293not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17294fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17295marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017296
17297 Example :
17298 frontend fnt
17299 mode tcp
17300 option tcplog
17301 log global
17302 default_backend bck
17303
17304 backend bck
17305 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17306
17307 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17308 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17309 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17310
17311 Field Format Extract from the example above
17312 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17313 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17314 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17315 4 frontend_name fnt
17316 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17317 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17318 7 bytes_read* 212
17319 8 termination_state --
17320 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17321 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17322
17323Detailed fields description :
17324 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017325 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17326 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17327 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017328 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017329 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017330 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017331
17332 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017333 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17334 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17335 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336
17337 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17338 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17339 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017340 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17341 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17342 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17343 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344
17345 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17346 and processed the connection.
17347
17348 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17349 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17350 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17351 applications.
17352
17353 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17354 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17355 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17356 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17357 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17358
17359 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17360 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17361 See "Timers" below for more details.
17362
17363 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17364 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17365 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17366 "Timers" below for more details.
17367
17368 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017369 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017370 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17371 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17372 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17373 details.
17374
17375 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17376 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17377 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17378 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17379 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17380
17381 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17382 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17383 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17384 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17385 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17386 for more details.
17387
17388 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017389 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17391 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17392 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017393 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017394
17395 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17396 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17397 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17398 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17399 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17400 caused by a denial of service attack.
17401
17402 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17403 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17404 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17405 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17406 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17407 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17408 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17409 denial of service attack.
17410
17411 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17412 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17413 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17414 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17415 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17416 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17417 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17418 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17419 be processed than on other servers.
17420
17421 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17422 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17423 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17424 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17425 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17426 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17427 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17428 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17429 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17430 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17431 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17432 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17433 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17434
17435 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17436 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17437 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17438 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17439 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17440 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017441 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017442 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17443
17444 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17445 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17446 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17447 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17448 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17449 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017450 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017451 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17452 occurs.
17453
17454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174558.2.3. HTTP log format
17456----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017457
17458The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17459is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17460the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17461are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17462emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17463generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17464"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17465which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017466frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17467is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468
17469Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17470slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17471with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17472
17473 Example :
17474 frontend http-in
17475 mode http
17476 option httplog
17477 log global
17478 default_backend bck
17479
17480 backend static
17481 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17482
17483 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17484 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17485 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017486 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487
17488 Field Format Extract from the example above
17489 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17490 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017491 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017492 4 frontend_name http-in
17493 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017494 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017495 7 status_code 200
17496 8 bytes_read* 2750
17497 9 captured_request_cookie -
17498 10 captured_response_cookie -
17499 11 termination_state ----
17500 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17501 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17502 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17503 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17504 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017505
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017506Detailed fields description :
17507 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017508 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17509 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17510 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017511 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017512 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017513 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017514
17515 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017516 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17517 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17518 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017520 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17521 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522
17523 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17524 and processed the connection.
17525
17526 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17527 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17528 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17529
17530 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17531 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17532 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17533 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17534 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17535 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17536
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017537 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17538 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17539 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017540 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017541 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17542 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017543 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17544 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017545
17546 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17547 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017548 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017549
17550 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17551 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017552 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17553 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017554
17555 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17556 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17557 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17558 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17559 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017560 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17561 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017563 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17564 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17565 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17566 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17567 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17568 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17569 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017570 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017571
17572 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17573 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17574 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17575
17576 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17577 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017578 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17580 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17581 overflowing.
17582
17583 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17584 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17585 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17586 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17587 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17588 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17589 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17590 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17591
17592 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17593 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17594 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17595 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17596 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17597 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17598 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17599 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17600
17601 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17602 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17603 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17604 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17605 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17606 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17607 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17608
17609 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017610 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017611 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17612 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17613 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017614 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017615 system.
17616
17617 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17618 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17619 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17620 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17621 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17622 caused by a denial of service attack.
17623
17624 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17625 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17626 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17627 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17628 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17629 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17630 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17631 denial of service attack.
17632
17633 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17634 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17635 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17636 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17637 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17638 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17639 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17640 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17641 processed than on other servers.
17642
17643 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17644 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17645 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17646 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17647 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17648 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17649 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17650 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17651 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17652 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17653 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17654 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17655 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17656
17657 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17658 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17659 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17660 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17661 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17662 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017663 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017664 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17665
17666 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17667 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17668 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17669 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17670 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17671 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017672 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17674 occurs.
17675
17676 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17677 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17678 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17679 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17680 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17681 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17682 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17683 cookies" below for more details.
17684
17685 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17686 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17687 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17688 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17689 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17690 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17691 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17692 and cookies" below for more details.
17693
17694 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17695 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17696 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17697 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17698 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17699 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17700 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17701 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17702
17703
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200177048.2.4. Custom log format
17705------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017706
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017707The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017708mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017709
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017710HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017711Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17712separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17713prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17714
17715Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17716variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017717("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017718
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017719If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017720as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017721less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17722the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17723
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017724Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017725In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017726in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017727
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017728Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17729'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17730https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17731such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017733Flags are :
17734 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017735 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017736 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17737 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017738
17739 Example:
17740
17741 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17742 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17743
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017744 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17745
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017746At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17747
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017748 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17749 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017750
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017751the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017752
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017753 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17754 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17755 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017756
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017757and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17758
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017759 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17760 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017761
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017762Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17763
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017764 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017765 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017766 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17767 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17768 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017769 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17770 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17771 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017772 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017773 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17774 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017775 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017776 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17777 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017778 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017779 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017780 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017781 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017782 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017783 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017784 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017785 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17786 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17787 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17788 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17789 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017790 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017791 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17792 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017793 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017794 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17795 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017796 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17797 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17798 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017799 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017800 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17801 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017802 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017803 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17804 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17805 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017806 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017807 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017808 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17809 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17810 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17811 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017812 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017813 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017814 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017815 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017816 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017817 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017818 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17819 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17820 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017821 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017822 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17823 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017824 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017825 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17826 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017827 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017828 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017829 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017830 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017831
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017832 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017833
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017834
178358.2.5. Error log format
17836-----------------------
17837
17838When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17839protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17840By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17841"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017842will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017843logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17844
17845The format looks like this :
17846
17847 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17848 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17849 Connection error during SSL handshake
17850
17851 Field Format Extract from the example above
17852 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17853 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17854 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17855 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17856 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17857
17858These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17859failures.
17860
17861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178628.3. Advanced logging options
17863-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864
17865Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17866just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17867options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17868for more information about their usage.
17869
17870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178718.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17872------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017873
17874It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17875haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17876commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17877monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17878ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17879
17880 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17881 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17882 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17883 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17884
17885 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17886 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17887 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017888 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017889 such as other load-balancers.
17890
17891 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17892 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17893 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17894
17895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17897----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898
17899The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17900what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17901or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017902"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017903just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17904log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17905after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17906is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17907with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17908with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17909
17910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179118.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17912------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017913
17914Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17915for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17916"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17917retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17918raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17919a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17920file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17921you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17922"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17923
17924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179258.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17926--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017927
17928Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17929multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17930them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17931"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17932logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17933error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17934and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17935too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17936useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17937alternative.
17938
17939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179408.4. Timing events
17941------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017942
17943Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17944reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17945the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17946frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017947mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17948addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17949
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017950Timings events in HTTP mode:
17951
17952 first request 2nd request
17953 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17954 t tr t tr ...
17955 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17956 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17957 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17958 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17959 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17960
17961Timings events in TCP mode:
17962
17963 TCP session
17964 |<----------------->|
17965 t t
17966 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17967 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17968 |<------ Tt ------->|
17969
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017970 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017971 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017972 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17973 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17974 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017975 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017976 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17977 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17978 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17979 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017981 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17982 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17983 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017984 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17985 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17986 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17987 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17988 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17989 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017990
17991 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17992 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17993 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17994 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17995 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17996 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17997 request typed by hand during a test.
17998
17999 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18000 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018001 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018002 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18003 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18004 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18005 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018006
18007 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18008 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18009 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18010 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18011 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18012
18013 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18014 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18015 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18016 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18017 connection never established.
18018
18019 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18020 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18021 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18022 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18023 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18024 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18025 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18026 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18027 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18028 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18029 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18030
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018031 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18032 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18033 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18034 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18035 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18036 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18037
18038 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18039
18040 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18041 "Ta" can never be negative.
18042
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018043 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18044 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018045 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18046 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018047 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018048
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018049 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018050
18051 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018052 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18053 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018054
18055These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18056protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18057that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018058due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18059"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18060that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018061
18062Most common cases :
18063
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018064 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18065 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18066 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18067 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18068 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18069 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18070 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18071 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18072 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18073 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18074 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018075 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018076
18077 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18078 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18079 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18080 of ms on remote networks.
18081
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018082 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18083 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18084 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018086 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18087 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18088 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18089 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18090 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18091 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18092 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18093 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18094 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018095
18096Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18097
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018098 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018099 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018100 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018101
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018102 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18104 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18105
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018106 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018107 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18108 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18109 flags.
18110
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018111 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18112 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018113 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18114 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18115 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18116 the client connection was maintained open.
18117
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018118 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018119 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018120 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018121 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18122
18123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181248.5. Session state at disconnection
18125-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018126
18127TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18128"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
181292-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18130each of which has a special meaning :
18131
18132 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18133 session to terminate :
18134
18135 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18136
18137 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18138 server explicitly refused it.
18139
18140 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18141 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18142 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18143 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018144 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018145
18146 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18147 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018148
18149 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18150 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18151 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18152 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18153 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18154
18155 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18156 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18157 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18158 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18159 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18160
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018161 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18162 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18163
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018164 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18165 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18166 backup connections when going up.
18167
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018168 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18169
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018170 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18171 send or receive data.
18172
18173 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18174 send or receive data.
18175
18176 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18177 with nothing left in the buffers.
18178
18179 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18180
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018181 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018182 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18183
18184 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18185 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18186 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18187 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18188 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18189
18190 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18191 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18192
18193 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18194 server (HTTP only).
18195
18196 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18197
18198 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18199 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18200 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18201
18202 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18203 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18204 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18205
18206 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18207
18208 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18209 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18210
18211 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18212 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18213 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18214
18215 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18216 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018217 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18218 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018219
18220 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18221 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18222 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18223 another server.
18224
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018225 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018226 server.
18227
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018228 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18229 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18230 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18231 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18232
18233 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18234 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18235 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18236 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18237
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018238 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18239 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18240 "use-server" rule).
18241
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018242 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18243
18244 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18245 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18246
18247 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18248
18249 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18250 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18251 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18252
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018253 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18254 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018255 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018256 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18257 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18258
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018259 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18260
18261 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18262 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18263
18264 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18265
18266 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18267
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018268The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18269was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018270helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18271starvation, attacks, etc...
18272
18273The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18274alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18275easier finding and understanding.
18276
18277 Flags Reason
18278
18279 -- Normal termination.
18280
18281 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18282 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18283 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18284 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18285
18286 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18287 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18288 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18289 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18290 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18291 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018292
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018293 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18294 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018295 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018296
18297 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18298 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18299 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18300
18301 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18302 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18303 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18304 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18305 the server takes too long to respond.
18306
18307 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18308 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18309 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18310 long a time to respond.
18311
18312 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18313 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18314 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18315 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018316 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18317 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018318
18319 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18320 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18321 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18322 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18323 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018324 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018325 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18326 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18327 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18328 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18329 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18330 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18331 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18332 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018333 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018334 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18335 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18336 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018337
18338 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18339 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018340 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18341 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18342 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18343 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018344
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018345 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18346 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018348 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018349 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18350 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018351 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018352 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18353 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18354
18355 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18356 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18357 503 or 504 here.
18358
18359 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18360 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18361 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18362 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18363 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18364
18365 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18366 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018367 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018368 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18369 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18370
18371 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18372 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18373 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18374 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18375 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18376 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18377 between haproxy and the server.
18378
18379 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18380 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18381 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18382 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18383 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18384 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18385 solution is to fix the application.
18386
18387 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18388 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18389 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18390 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18391 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18392 external attacks.
18393
18394 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18395 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018396 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018397 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18398 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18399
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018400 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18401 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18402 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018403 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018404 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018405
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018406 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18407 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18408 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18409 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018410 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18411 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18412 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18413 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18414 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018415
18416 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18417 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18418 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18419 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18420
18421 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18422 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18423 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18424 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18425
18426 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18427 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18428 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18429 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18430
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018431The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18432persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18433important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18434re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18435
18436 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18437
18438 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18439 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18440 set on a GET request.
18441
18442 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18443 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018444 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018445 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18446
18447 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18448 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18449 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18450
18451 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18452 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18453 already got a cookie.
18454
18455 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18456 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18457 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18458 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18459 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18460
18461 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18462 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18463 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18464
18465 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18466 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18467 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18468
18469 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18470 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18471
18472 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18473 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18474 then advertised in the response.
18475
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184778.6. Non-printable characters
18478-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018479
18480In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18481consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18482converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18483prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18484being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18485escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18486is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18487'}' when logging headers.
18488
18489Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18490issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18491containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18492
18493Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18494the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18495performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18496
18497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18499---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018500
18501Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18502achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018503section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018504cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18505the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18506the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018507locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018508not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18509user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18510a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18511wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18512
18513 Examples :
18514 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18515 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18516
18517 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18518 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18519
18520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185218.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18522---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018523
18524Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18525proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18526the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18527server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18528
18529Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18530response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018531section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018532
18533It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018534time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18535appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018536are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18537and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18538follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18539request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18540in the logs.
18541
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018542As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18543frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18544an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18545
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018546 Example :
18547 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18548 listen proxy-out
18549 mode http
18550 option httplog
18551 option logasap
18552 log global
18553 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18554
18555 # log the name of the virtual server
18556 capture request header Host len 20
18557
18558 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18559 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18560
18561 # log the beginning of the referrer
18562 capture request header Referer len 20
18563
18564 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18565 capture response header Server len 20
18566
18567 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18568 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18569
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018570 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018571 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18572
18573 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18574 capture response header Via len 20
18575
18576 # log the URL location during a redirection
18577 capture response header Location len 20
18578
18579 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18580 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18581 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18582 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18583 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18584
18585 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18586 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18587 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18588 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018589 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018590
18591 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18592 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18593 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18594 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18595 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018596 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018597
18598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185998.9. Examples of logs
18600---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018601
18602These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18603them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18604reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18605
18606 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18607 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18608 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18609
18610 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18611 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18612
18613 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18614 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18615 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18616
18617 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18618 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18619
18620 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18621 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18622 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18623
18624 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018625 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018626 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18627 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18628
18629 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18630 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18631 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18632
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018633 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18634 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18635 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18636 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18637 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18638 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018639
18640 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018641 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018642
18643 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18644 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18645 Nothing was sent to any server.
18646
18647 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18648 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18649
18650 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18651 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018652 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018653 send a 408 return code to the client.
18654
18655 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18656 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18657
18658 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18659 5 seconds ("c----").
18660
18661 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18662 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018663 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018664
18665 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018666 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018667 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18668 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18669 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18670 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18671 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018672
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018673
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200186749. Supported filters
18675--------------------
18676
18677Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18678accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18679unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18680
18681See also : "filter"
18682
186839.1. Trace
18684----------
18685
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018686filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018687
18688 Arguments:
18689 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18690 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18691
18692 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18693 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18694 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18695 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018697 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018698 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18699 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18700 amount of the parsed data.
18701
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018702 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018703
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018704This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18705callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18706information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18707filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18708
18709Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18710tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18711a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18712
18713
187149.2. HTTP compression
18715---------------------
18716
18717filter compression
18718
18719The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18720keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018721when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18722fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18723done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18724explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18725filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18726listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18727order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018728
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018729See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18730 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018731
18732
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200187339.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18734--------------------------------------------
18735
18736filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18737
18738 Arguments :
18739
18740 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18741 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18742 parsed.
18743
18744 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18745 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18746 part must be placed in its own scope.
18747
18748The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18749external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018750streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018751exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18752also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18753
18754SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18755the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18756
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018757For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018758"doc/SPOE.txt".
18759
18760Important note:
18761 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18762 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18763
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100187649.4. Cache
18765----------
18766
18767filter cache <name>
18768
18769 Arguments :
18770
18771 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18772
18773The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18774"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018775cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018776other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18777case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18778is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18779filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018780listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18781order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018782
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018783See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18784 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18785
18786
187879.5. Fcgi-app
18788-------------
18789
18790filter fcg-app <name>
18791
18792 Arguments :
18793
18794 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18795
18796The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18797request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18798reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18799used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18800implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18801used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18802fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18803used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18804order.
18805
18806See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18807 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18808
18809
1881010. FastCGI applications
18811-------------------------
18812
18813HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18814feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18815the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18816FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18817servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18818FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18819backend.
18820
18821HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18822application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18823connection.
18824
1882510.1. Setup
18826-----------
18827
1882810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18829--------------------------
18830
18831fcgi-app <name>
18832 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18833 document root must be defined.
18834
18835acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18836 Declare or complete an access list.
18837
18838 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18839 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18840 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18841 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18842 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18843
18844docroot <path>
18845 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18846 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18847 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18848
18849index <script-name>
18850 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18851 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18852 is an optional setting.
18853
18854 Example :
18855 index index.php
18856
18857log-stderr global
18858log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18859 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18860 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18861
18862 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18863 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18864
18865pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18866 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18867 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18868 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18869
18870 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18871 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18872 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18873 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18874
18875 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18876 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18877
18878path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018879 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018880 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18881 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18882 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18883 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18884 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18885 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18886 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018887
18888 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018889 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018890 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18891 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18892 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18893 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018894
18895 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018896 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18897 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018898
18899option get-values
18900no option get-values
18901 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18902
18903 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18904 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18905
18906 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18907 application will accept.
18908
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018909 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18910 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018911
18912 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18913 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18914 option is disabled.
18915
18916 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18917 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18918 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18919 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18920 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18921 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18922
18923option keep-conn
18924no option keep-conn
18925 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18926 sending a response.
18927
18928 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18929 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18930
18931option max-reqs <reqs>
18932 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18933 accept.
18934
18935 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18936 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18937 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18938 to 1.
18939
18940option mpxs-conns
18941no option mpxs-conns
18942 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18943
18944 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18945 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18946
18947set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18948 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18949 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18950 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18951 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18952
18953 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18954 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18955 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18956
18957 Example :
18958 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18959 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18960
18961 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18962
18963
1896410.1.2. Proxy section
18965---------------------
18966
18967use-fcgi-app <name>
18968 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18969
18970 Arguments :
18971 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18972
18973 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18974 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18975 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18976 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18977 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18978
18979 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18980 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18981 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18982 application are evaluated.
18983
18984
1898510.1.3. Example
18986---------------
18987
18988 frontend front-http
18989 mode http
18990 bind *:80
18991 bind *:
18992
18993 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18994 default_backend back-static
18995
18996 backend back-static
18997 mode http
18998 server www A.B.C.D:80
18999
19000 backend back-dynamic
19001 mode http
19002 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19003 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19004
19005 fcgi-app php-fpm
19006 log-stderr global
19007 option keep-conn
19008
19009 docroot /var/www/my-app
19010 index index.php
19011 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19012
19013
1901410.2. Default parameters
19015------------------------
19016
19017A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19018the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019019script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019020applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19021
19022 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19023 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19024 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19025 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19026 | | |
19027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19028 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19029 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19030 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19031 | | application. |
19032 | | |
19033 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19034 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19035 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19036 | | |
19037 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19038 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19039 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19040 | | the application's configuration. |
19041 | | |
19042 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19043 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19044 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19045 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19046 | | |
19047 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19048 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19049 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19050 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19051 | | be defined. |
19052 | | |
19053 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19054 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19055 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19056 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19057 | | is not set too. |
19058 | | |
19059 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19060 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19061 | | set. |
19062 | | |
19063 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19064 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19065 | | the request. |
19066 | | |
19067 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19068 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19069 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19070 | | |
19071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19072 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19073 | | script to process the request. |
19074 | | |
19075 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19076 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19077 | | |
19078 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19079 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19080 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19081 | | |
19082 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19083 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19084 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19085 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19086 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19087 | | |
19088 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19089 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19090 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19091 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19092 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19093 | | side. |
19094 | | |
19095 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19096 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19097 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19098 | | connected to. |
19099 | | |
19100 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19101 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19102 | | |
19103 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19104 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19105 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19106 | | |
19107 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19108
19109
1911010.3. Limitations
19111------------------
19112
19113The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19114way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19115during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19116establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19117application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19118or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19119message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19120these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19121and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19122
19123Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19124request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19125requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19126
19127About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19128into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19129fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19130"http-request" ones.
19131
19132Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19133FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19134processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19135must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19136here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019138/*
19139 * Local variables:
19140 * fill-column: 79
19141 * End:
19142 */